mirror of https://gitee.com/openkylin/linux.git
Merge commit 'v2.6.28-rc1' into sched/urgent
This commit is contained in:
commit
8c82a17e9c
1
.mailmap
1
.mailmap
|
@ -66,6 +66,7 @@ Kenneth W Chen <kenneth.w.chen@intel.com>
|
|||
Koushik <raghavendra.koushik@neterion.com>
|
||||
Leonid I Ananiev <leonid.i.ananiev@intel.com>
|
||||
Linas Vepstas <linas@austin.ibm.com>
|
||||
Mark Brown <broonie@sirena.org.uk>
|
||||
Matthieu CASTET <castet.matthieu@free.fr>
|
||||
Michael Buesch <mb@bu3sch.de>
|
||||
Michael Buesch <mbuesch@freenet.de>
|
||||
|
|
23
CREDITS
23
CREDITS
|
@ -598,6 +598,11 @@ S: Tamsui town, Taipei county,
|
|||
S: Taiwan 251
|
||||
S: Republic of China
|
||||
|
||||
N: Reinette Chatre
|
||||
E: reinette.chatre@intel.com
|
||||
D: WiMedia Link Protocol implementation
|
||||
D: UWB stack bits and pieces
|
||||
|
||||
N: Michael Elizabeth Chastain
|
||||
E: mec@shout.net
|
||||
D: Configure, Menuconfig, xconfig
|
||||
|
@ -1653,14 +1658,14 @@ S: Chapel Hill, North Carolina 27514-4818
|
|||
S: USA
|
||||
|
||||
N: Dave Jones
|
||||
E: davej@codemonkey.org.uk
|
||||
E: davej@redhat.com
|
||||
W: http://www.codemonkey.org.uk
|
||||
D: x86 errata/setup maintenance.
|
||||
D: AGPGART driver.
|
||||
D: Assorted VIA x86 support.
|
||||
D: 2.5 AGPGART overhaul.
|
||||
D: CPUFREQ maintenance.
|
||||
D: Backport/Forwardport merge monkey.
|
||||
D: Various Janitor work.
|
||||
S: United Kingdom
|
||||
D: Fedora kernel maintainence.
|
||||
D: Misc/Other.
|
||||
S: 314 Littleton Rd, Westford, MA 01886, USA
|
||||
|
||||
N: Martin Josfsson
|
||||
E: gandalf@wlug.westbo.se
|
||||
|
@ -2695,6 +2700,12 @@ S: Demonstratsii 8-382
|
|||
S: Tula 300000
|
||||
S: Russia
|
||||
|
||||
N: Inaky Perez-Gonzalez
|
||||
E: inaky.perez-gonzalez@intel.com
|
||||
D: UWB stack, HWA-RC driver and HWA-HC drivers
|
||||
D: Wireless USB additions to the USB stack
|
||||
D: WiMedia Link Protocol bits and pieces
|
||||
|
||||
N: Gordon Peters
|
||||
E: GordPeters@smarttech.com
|
||||
D: Isochronous receive for IEEE 1394 driver (OHCI module).
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,62 @@
|
|||
What: /sys/bus/usb/drivers/usbtmc/devices/*/interface_capabilities
|
||||
What: /sys/bus/usb/drivers/usbtmc/devices/*/device_capabilities
|
||||
Date: August 2008
|
||||
Contact: Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@suse.de>
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
These files show the various USB TMC capabilities as described
|
||||
by the device itself. The full description of the bitfields
|
||||
can be found in the USB TMC documents from the USB-IF entitled
|
||||
"Universal Serial Bus Test and Measurement Class Specification
|
||||
(USBTMC) Revision 1.0" section 4.2.1.8.
|
||||
|
||||
The files are read only.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/bus/usb/drivers/usbtmc/devices/*/usb488_interface_capabilities
|
||||
What: /sys/bus/usb/drivers/usbtmc/devices/*/usb488_device_capabilities
|
||||
Date: August 2008
|
||||
Contact: Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@suse.de>
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
These files show the various USB TMC capabilities as described
|
||||
by the device itself. The full description of the bitfields
|
||||
can be found in the USB TMC documents from the USB-IF entitled
|
||||
"Universal Serial Bus Test and Measurement Class, Subclass
|
||||
USB488 Specification (USBTMC-USB488) Revision 1.0" section
|
||||
4.2.2.
|
||||
|
||||
The files are read only.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/bus/usb/drivers/usbtmc/devices/*/TermChar
|
||||
Date: August 2008
|
||||
Contact: Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@suse.de>
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
This file is the TermChar value to be sent to the USB TMC
|
||||
device as described by the document, "Universal Serial Bus Test
|
||||
and Measurement Class Specification
|
||||
(USBTMC) Revision 1.0" as published by the USB-IF.
|
||||
|
||||
Note that the TermCharEnabled file determines if this value is
|
||||
sent to the device or not.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/bus/usb/drivers/usbtmc/devices/*/TermCharEnabled
|
||||
Date: August 2008
|
||||
Contact: Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@suse.de>
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
This file determines if the TermChar is to be sent to the
|
||||
device on every transaction or not. For more details about
|
||||
this, please see the document, "Universal Serial Bus Test and
|
||||
Measurement Class Specification (USBTMC) Revision 1.0" as
|
||||
published by the USB-IF.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/bus/usb/drivers/usbtmc/devices/*/auto_abort
|
||||
Date: August 2008
|
||||
Contact: Greg Kroah-Hartman <gregkh@suse.de>
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
This file determines if the the transaction of the USB TMC
|
||||
device is to be automatically aborted if there is any error.
|
||||
For more details about this, please see the document,
|
||||
"Universal Serial Bus Test and Measurement Class Specification
|
||||
(USBTMC) Revision 1.0" as published by the USB-IF.
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,28 @@
|
|||
What: /sys/bus/umc/
|
||||
Date: July 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: David Vrabel <david.vrabel@csr.com>
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
The Wireless Host Controller Interface (WHCI)
|
||||
specification describes a PCI-based device with
|
||||
multiple capabilities; the UWB Multi-interface
|
||||
Controller (UMC).
|
||||
|
||||
The umc bus presents each of the individual
|
||||
capabilties as a device.
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/bus/umc/devices/.../capability_id
|
||||
Date: July 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: David Vrabel <david.vrabel@csr.com>
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
The ID of this capability, with 0 being the radio
|
||||
controller capability.
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/bus/umc/devices/.../version
|
||||
Date: July 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: David Vrabel <david.vrabel@csr.com>
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
The specification version this capability's hardware
|
||||
interface complies with.
|
|
@ -85,3 +85,62 @@ Description:
|
|||
Users:
|
||||
PowerTOP <power@bughost.org>
|
||||
http://www.lesswatts.org/projects/powertop/
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/bus/usb/device/<busnum>-<devnum>...:<config num>-<interface num>/supports_autosuspend
|
||||
Date: January 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: Sarah Sharp <sarah.a.sharp@intel.com>
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
When read, this file returns 1 if the interface driver
|
||||
for this interface supports autosuspend. It also
|
||||
returns 1 if no driver has claimed this interface, as an
|
||||
unclaimed interface will not stop the device from being
|
||||
autosuspended if all other interface drivers are idle.
|
||||
The file returns 0 if autosuspend support has not been
|
||||
added to the driver.
|
||||
Users:
|
||||
USB PM tool
|
||||
git://git.moblin.org/users/sarah/usb-pm-tool/
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/bus/usb/device/.../authorized
|
||||
Date: July 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.26
|
||||
Contact: David Vrabel <david.vrabel@csr.com>
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
Authorized devices are available for use by device
|
||||
drivers, non-authorized one are not. By default, wired
|
||||
USB devices are authorized.
|
||||
|
||||
Certified Wireless USB devices are not authorized
|
||||
initially and should be (by writing 1) after the
|
||||
device has been authenticated.
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/bus/usb/device/.../wusb_cdid
|
||||
Date: July 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: David Vrabel <david.vrabel@csr.com>
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
For Certified Wireless USB devices only.
|
||||
|
||||
A devices's CDID, as 16 space-separated hex octets.
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/bus/usb/device/.../wusb_ck
|
||||
Date: July 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: David Vrabel <david.vrabel@csr.com>
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
For Certified Wireless USB devices only.
|
||||
|
||||
Write the device's connection key (CK) to start the
|
||||
authentication of the device. The CK is 16
|
||||
space-separated hex octets.
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/bus/usb/device/.../wusb_disconnect
|
||||
Date: July 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: David Vrabel <david.vrabel@csr.com>
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
For Certified Wireless USB devices only.
|
||||
|
||||
Write a 1 to force the device to disconnect
|
||||
(equivalent to unplugging a wired USB device).
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,43 @@
|
|||
Where: /sys/bus/usb/.../powered
|
||||
Date: August 2008
|
||||
Kernel Version: 2.6.26
|
||||
Contact: Harrison Metzger <harrisonmetz@gmail.com>
|
||||
Description: Controls whether the device's display will powered.
|
||||
A value of 0 is off and a non-zero value is on.
|
||||
|
||||
Where: /sys/bus/usb/.../mode_msb
|
||||
Where: /sys/bus/usb/.../mode_lsb
|
||||
Date: August 2008
|
||||
Kernel Version: 2.6.26
|
||||
Contact: Harrison Metzger <harrisonmetz@gmail.com>
|
||||
Description: Controls the devices display mode.
|
||||
For a 6 character display the values are
|
||||
MSB 0x06; LSB 0x3F, and
|
||||
for an 8 character display the values are
|
||||
MSB 0x08; LSB 0xFF.
|
||||
|
||||
Where: /sys/bus/usb/.../textmode
|
||||
Date: August 2008
|
||||
Kernel Version: 2.6.26
|
||||
Contact: Harrison Metzger <harrisonmetz@gmail.com>
|
||||
Description: Controls the way the device interprets its text buffer.
|
||||
raw: each character controls its segment manually
|
||||
hex: each character is between 0-15
|
||||
ascii: each character is between '0'-'9' and 'A'-'F'.
|
||||
|
||||
Where: /sys/bus/usb/.../text
|
||||
Date: August 2008
|
||||
Kernel Version: 2.6.26
|
||||
Contact: Harrison Metzger <harrisonmetz@gmail.com>
|
||||
Description: The text (or data) for the device to display
|
||||
|
||||
Where: /sys/bus/usb/.../decimals
|
||||
Date: August 2008
|
||||
Kernel Version: 2.6.26
|
||||
Contact: Harrison Metzger <harrisonmetz@gmail.com>
|
||||
Description: Controls the decimal places on the device.
|
||||
To set the nth decimal place, give this field
|
||||
the value of 10 ** n. Assume this field has
|
||||
the value k and has 1 or more decimal places set,
|
||||
to set the mth place (where m is not already set),
|
||||
change this fields value to k + 10 ** m.
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,25 @@
|
|||
What: /sys/class/usb_host/usb_hostN/wusb_chid
|
||||
Date: July 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: David Vrabel <david.vrabel@csr.com>
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
Write the CHID (16 space-separated hex octets) for this host controller.
|
||||
This starts the host controller, allowing it to accept connection from
|
||||
WUSB devices.
|
||||
|
||||
Set an all zero CHID to stop the host controller.
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/class/usb_host/usb_hostN/wusb_trust_timeout
|
||||
Date: July 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: David Vrabel <david.vrabel@csr.com>
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
Devices that haven't sent a WUSB packet to the host
|
||||
within 'wusb_trust_timeout' ms are considered to have
|
||||
disconnected and are removed. The default value of
|
||||
4000 ms is the value required by the WUSB
|
||||
specification.
|
||||
|
||||
Since this relates to security (specifically, the
|
||||
lifetime of PTKs and GTKs) it should not be changed
|
||||
from the default.
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,144 @@
|
|||
What: /sys/class/uwb_rc
|
||||
Date: July 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: linux-usb@vger.kernel.org
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
Interfaces for WiMedia Ultra Wideband Common Radio
|
||||
Platform (UWB) radio controllers.
|
||||
|
||||
Familiarity with the ECMA-368 'High Rate Ultra
|
||||
Wideband MAC and PHY Specification' is assumed.
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/class/uwb_rc/beacon_timeout_ms
|
||||
Date: July 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
If no beacons are received from a device for at least
|
||||
this time, the device will be considered to have gone
|
||||
and it will be removed. The default is 3 superframes
|
||||
(~197 ms) as required by the specification.
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/class/uwb_rc/uwbN/
|
||||
Date: July 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: linux-usb@vger.kernel.org
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
An individual UWB radio controller.
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/class/uwb_rc/uwbN/beacon
|
||||
Date: July 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: linux-usb@vger.kernel.org
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
Write:
|
||||
|
||||
<channel> [<bpst offset>]
|
||||
|
||||
to start beaconing on a specific channel, or stop
|
||||
beaconing if <channel> is -1. Valid channels depends
|
||||
on the radio controller's supported band groups.
|
||||
|
||||
<bpst offset> may be used to try and join a specific
|
||||
beacon group if more than one was found during a scan.
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/class/uwb_rc/uwbN/scan
|
||||
Date: July 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: linux-usb@vger.kernel.org
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
Write:
|
||||
|
||||
<channel> <type> [<bpst offset>]
|
||||
|
||||
to start (or stop) scanning on a channel. <type> is one of:
|
||||
0 - scan
|
||||
1 - scan outside BP
|
||||
2 - scan while inactive
|
||||
3 - scanning disabled
|
||||
4 - scan (with start time of <bpst offset>)
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/class/uwb_rc/uwbN/mac_address
|
||||
Date: July 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: linux-usb@vger.kernel.org
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
The EUI-48, in colon-separated hex octets, for this
|
||||
radio controller. A write will change the radio
|
||||
controller's EUI-48 but only do so while the device is
|
||||
not beaconing or scanning.
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/class/uwb_rc/uwbN/wusbhc
|
||||
Date: July 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: linux-usb@vger.kernel.org
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
A symlink to the device (if any) of the WUSB Host
|
||||
Controller PAL using this radio controller.
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/class/uwb_rc/uwbN/<EUI-48>/
|
||||
Date: July 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: linux-usb@vger.kernel.org
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
A neighbour UWB device that has either been detected
|
||||
as part of a scan or is a member of the radio
|
||||
controllers beacon group.
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/class/uwb_rc/uwbN/<EUI-48>/BPST
|
||||
Date: July 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: linux-usb@vger.kernel.org
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
The time (using the radio controllers internal 1 ms
|
||||
interval superframe timer) of the last beacon from
|
||||
this device was received.
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/class/uwb_rc/uwbN/<EUI-48>/DevAddr
|
||||
Date: July 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: linux-usb@vger.kernel.org
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
The current DevAddr of this device in colon separated
|
||||
hex octets.
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/class/uwb_rc/uwbN/<EUI-48>/EUI_48
|
||||
Date: July 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: linux-usb@vger.kernel.org
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
|
||||
The EUI-48 of this device in colon separated hex
|
||||
octets.
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/class/uwb_rc/uwbN/<EUI-48>/BPST
|
||||
Date: July 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: linux-usb@vger.kernel.org
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/class/uwb_rc/uwbN/<EUI-48>/IEs
|
||||
Date: July 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: linux-usb@vger.kernel.org
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
The latest IEs included in this device's beacon, in
|
||||
space separated hex octets with one IE per line.
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/class/uwb_rc/uwbN/<EUI-48>/LQE
|
||||
Date: July 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: linux-usb@vger.kernel.org
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
Link Quality Estimate - the Signal to Noise Ratio
|
||||
(SNR) of all packets received from this device in dB.
|
||||
This gives an estimate on a suitable PHY rate. Refer
|
||||
to [ECMA-368] section 13.3 for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/class/uwb_rc/uwbN/<EUI-48>/RSSI
|
||||
Date: July 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: linux-usb@vger.kernel.org
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
Received Signal Strength Indication - the strength of
|
||||
the received signal in dB. LQE is a more useful
|
||||
measure of the radio link quality.
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,100 @@
|
|||
What: /sys/bus/usb/drivers/wusb_cbaf/.../wusb_*
|
||||
Date: August 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: David Vrabel <david.vrabel@csr.com>
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
Various files for managing Cable Based Association of
|
||||
(wireless) USB devices.
|
||||
|
||||
The sequence of operations should be:
|
||||
|
||||
1. Device is plugged in.
|
||||
|
||||
2. The connection manager (CM) sees a device with CBA capability.
|
||||
(the wusb_chid etc. files in /sys/devices/blah/OURDEVICE).
|
||||
|
||||
3. The CM writes the host name, supported band groups,
|
||||
and the CHID (host ID) into the wusb_host_name,
|
||||
wusb_host_band_groups and wusb_chid files. These
|
||||
get sent to the device and the CDID (if any) for
|
||||
this host is requested.
|
||||
|
||||
4. The CM can verify that the device's supported band
|
||||
groups (wusb_device_band_groups) are compatible
|
||||
with the host.
|
||||
|
||||
5. The CM reads the wusb_cdid file.
|
||||
|
||||
6. The CM looks it up its database.
|
||||
|
||||
- If it has a matching CHID,CDID entry, the device
|
||||
has been authorized before and nothing further
|
||||
needs to be done.
|
||||
|
||||
- If the CDID is zero (or the CM doesn't find a
|
||||
matching CDID in its database), the device is
|
||||
assumed to be not known. The CM may associate
|
||||
the host with device by: writing a randomly
|
||||
generated CDID to wusb_cdid and then a random CK
|
||||
to wusb_ck (this uploads the new CC to the
|
||||
device).
|
||||
|
||||
CMD may choose to prompt the user before
|
||||
associating with a new device.
|
||||
|
||||
7. Device is unplugged.
|
||||
|
||||
References:
|
||||
[WUSB-AM] Association Models Supplement to the
|
||||
Certified Wireless Universal Serial Bus
|
||||
Specification, version 1.0.
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/bus/usb/drivers/wusb_cbaf/.../wusb_chid
|
||||
Date: August 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: David Vrabel <david.vrabel@csr.com>
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
The CHID of the host formatted as 16 space-separated
|
||||
hex octets.
|
||||
|
||||
Writes fetches device's supported band groups and the
|
||||
the CDID for any existing association with this host.
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/bus/usb/drivers/wusb_cbaf/.../wusb_host_name
|
||||
Date: August 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: David Vrabel <david.vrabel@csr.com>
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
A friendly name for the host as a UTF-8 encoded string.
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/bus/usb/drivers/wusb_cbaf/.../wusb_host_band_groups
|
||||
Date: August 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: David Vrabel <david.vrabel@csr.com>
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
The band groups supported by the host, in the format
|
||||
defined in [WUSB-AM].
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/bus/usb/drivers/wusb_cbaf/.../wusb_device_band_groups
|
||||
Date: August 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: David Vrabel <david.vrabel@csr.com>
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
The band groups supported by the device, in the format
|
||||
defined in [WUSB-AM].
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/bus/usb/drivers/wusb_cbaf/.../wusb_cdid
|
||||
Date: August 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: David Vrabel <david.vrabel@csr.com>
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
The device's CDID formatted as 16 space-separated hex
|
||||
octets.
|
||||
|
||||
What: /sys/bus/usb/drivers/wusb_cbaf/.../wusb_ck
|
||||
Date: August 2008
|
||||
KernelVersion: 2.6.27
|
||||
Contact: David Vrabel <david.vrabel@csr.com>
|
||||
Description:
|
||||
Write 16 space-separated random, hex octets to
|
||||
associate with the device.
|
|
@ -557,6 +557,9 @@ Near-term plans include converting all of them, except for "gadgetfs".
|
|||
</para>
|
||||
|
||||
!Edrivers/usb/gadget/f_acm.c
|
||||
!Edrivers/usb/gadget/f_ecm.c
|
||||
!Edrivers/usb/gadget/f_subset.c
|
||||
!Edrivers/usb/gadget/f_obex.c
|
||||
!Edrivers/usb/gadget/f_serial.c
|
||||
|
||||
</sect1>
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -1105,7 +1105,7 @@ static struct block_device_operations opt_fops = {
|
|||
</listitem>
|
||||
<listitem>
|
||||
<para>
|
||||
Function names as strings (__FUNCTION__).
|
||||
Function names as strings (__func__).
|
||||
</para>
|
||||
</listitem>
|
||||
<listitem>
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -236,10 +236,8 @@ software system can set different pages for controlling accesses to the
|
|||
MSI-X structure. The implementation of MSI support requires the PCI
|
||||
subsystem, not a device driver, to maintain full control of the MSI-X
|
||||
table/MSI-X PBA (Pending Bit Array) and MMIO address space of the MSI-X
|
||||
table/MSI-X PBA. A device driver is prohibited from requesting the MMIO
|
||||
address space of the MSI-X table/MSI-X PBA. Otherwise, the PCI subsystem
|
||||
will fail enabling MSI-X on its hardware device when it calls the function
|
||||
pci_enable_msix().
|
||||
table/MSI-X PBA. A device driver should not access the MMIO address
|
||||
space of the MSI-X table/MSI-X PBA.
|
||||
|
||||
5.3.2 API pci_enable_msix
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -163,6 +163,10 @@ need pass only as many optional fields as necessary:
|
|||
o class and classmask fields default to 0
|
||||
o driver_data defaults to 0UL.
|
||||
|
||||
Note that driver_data must match the value used by any of the pci_device_id
|
||||
entries defined in the driver. This makes the driver_data field mandatory
|
||||
if all the pci_device_id entries have a non-zero driver_data value.
|
||||
|
||||
Once added, the driver probe routine will be invoked for any unclaimed
|
||||
PCI devices listed in its (newly updated) pci_ids list.
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -203,22 +203,17 @@ to mmio_enabled.
|
|||
|
||||
3.3 helper functions
|
||||
|
||||
3.3.1 int pci_find_aer_capability(struct pci_dev *dev);
|
||||
pci_find_aer_capability locates the PCI Express AER capability
|
||||
in the device configuration space. If the device doesn't support
|
||||
PCI-Express AER, the function returns 0.
|
||||
|
||||
3.3.2 int pci_enable_pcie_error_reporting(struct pci_dev *dev);
|
||||
3.3.1 int pci_enable_pcie_error_reporting(struct pci_dev *dev);
|
||||
pci_enable_pcie_error_reporting enables the device to send error
|
||||
messages to root port when an error is detected. Note that devices
|
||||
don't enable the error reporting by default, so device drivers need
|
||||
call this function to enable it.
|
||||
|
||||
3.3.3 int pci_disable_pcie_error_reporting(struct pci_dev *dev);
|
||||
3.3.2 int pci_disable_pcie_error_reporting(struct pci_dev *dev);
|
||||
pci_disable_pcie_error_reporting disables the device to send error
|
||||
messages to root port when an error is detected.
|
||||
|
||||
3.3.4 int pci_cleanup_aer_uncorrect_error_status(struct pci_dev *dev);
|
||||
3.3.3 int pci_cleanup_aer_uncorrect_error_status(struct pci_dev *dev);
|
||||
pci_cleanup_aer_uncorrect_error_status cleanups the uncorrectable
|
||||
error status register.
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,99 @@
|
|||
The cgroup freezer is useful to batch job management system which start
|
||||
and stop sets of tasks in order to schedule the resources of a machine
|
||||
according to the desires of a system administrator. This sort of program
|
||||
is often used on HPC clusters to schedule access to the cluster as a
|
||||
whole. The cgroup freezer uses cgroups to describe the set of tasks to
|
||||
be started/stopped by the batch job management system. It also provides
|
||||
a means to start and stop the tasks composing the job.
|
||||
|
||||
The cgroup freezer will also be useful for checkpointing running groups
|
||||
of tasks. The freezer allows the checkpoint code to obtain a consistent
|
||||
image of the tasks by attempting to force the tasks in a cgroup into a
|
||||
quiescent state. Once the tasks are quiescent another task can
|
||||
walk /proc or invoke a kernel interface to gather information about the
|
||||
quiesced tasks. Checkpointed tasks can be restarted later should a
|
||||
recoverable error occur. This also allows the checkpointed tasks to be
|
||||
migrated between nodes in a cluster by copying the gathered information
|
||||
to another node and restarting the tasks there.
|
||||
|
||||
Sequences of SIGSTOP and SIGCONT are not always sufficient for stopping
|
||||
and resuming tasks in userspace. Both of these signals are observable
|
||||
from within the tasks we wish to freeze. While SIGSTOP cannot be caught,
|
||||
blocked, or ignored it can be seen by waiting or ptracing parent tasks.
|
||||
SIGCONT is especially unsuitable since it can be caught by the task. Any
|
||||
programs designed to watch for SIGSTOP and SIGCONT could be broken by
|
||||
attempting to use SIGSTOP and SIGCONT to stop and resume tasks. We can
|
||||
demonstrate this problem using nested bash shells:
|
||||
|
||||
$ echo $$
|
||||
16644
|
||||
$ bash
|
||||
$ echo $$
|
||||
16690
|
||||
|
||||
From a second, unrelated bash shell:
|
||||
$ kill -SIGSTOP 16690
|
||||
$ kill -SIGCONT 16990
|
||||
|
||||
<at this point 16990 exits and causes 16644 to exit too>
|
||||
|
||||
This happens because bash can observe both signals and choose how it
|
||||
responds to them.
|
||||
|
||||
Another example of a program which catches and responds to these
|
||||
signals is gdb. In fact any program designed to use ptrace is likely to
|
||||
have a problem with this method of stopping and resuming tasks.
|
||||
|
||||
In contrast, the cgroup freezer uses the kernel freezer code to
|
||||
prevent the freeze/unfreeze cycle from becoming visible to the tasks
|
||||
being frozen. This allows the bash example above and gdb to run as
|
||||
expected.
|
||||
|
||||
The freezer subsystem in the container filesystem defines a file named
|
||||
freezer.state. Writing "FROZEN" to the state file will freeze all tasks in the
|
||||
cgroup. Subsequently writing "THAWED" will unfreeze the tasks in the cgroup.
|
||||
Reading will return the current state.
|
||||
|
||||
* Examples of usage :
|
||||
|
||||
# mkdir /containers/freezer
|
||||
# mount -t cgroup -ofreezer freezer /containers
|
||||
# mkdir /containers/0
|
||||
# echo $some_pid > /containers/0/tasks
|
||||
|
||||
to get status of the freezer subsystem :
|
||||
|
||||
# cat /containers/0/freezer.state
|
||||
THAWED
|
||||
|
||||
to freeze all tasks in the container :
|
||||
|
||||
# echo FROZEN > /containers/0/freezer.state
|
||||
# cat /containers/0/freezer.state
|
||||
FREEZING
|
||||
# cat /containers/0/freezer.state
|
||||
FROZEN
|
||||
|
||||
to unfreeze all tasks in the container :
|
||||
|
||||
# echo THAWED > /containers/0/freezer.state
|
||||
# cat /containers/0/freezer.state
|
||||
THAWED
|
||||
|
||||
This is the basic mechanism which should do the right thing for user space task
|
||||
in a simple scenario.
|
||||
|
||||
It's important to note that freezing can be incomplete. In that case we return
|
||||
EBUSY. This means that some tasks in the cgroup are busy doing something that
|
||||
prevents us from completely freezing the cgroup at this time. After EBUSY,
|
||||
the cgroup will remain partially frozen -- reflected by freezer.state reporting
|
||||
"FREEZING" when read. The state will remain "FREEZING" until one of these
|
||||
things happens:
|
||||
|
||||
1) Userspace cancels the freezing operation by writing "THAWED" to
|
||||
the freezer.state file
|
||||
2) Userspace retries the freezing operation by writing "FROZEN" to
|
||||
the freezer.state file (writing "FREEZING" is not legal
|
||||
and returns EIO)
|
||||
3) The tasks that blocked the cgroup from entering the "FROZEN"
|
||||
state disappear from the cgroup's set of tasks.
|
|
@ -112,14 +112,22 @@ the per cgroup LRU.
|
|||
|
||||
2.2.1 Accounting details
|
||||
|
||||
All mapped pages (RSS) and unmapped user pages (Page Cache) are accounted.
|
||||
RSS pages are accounted at the time of page_add_*_rmap() unless they've already
|
||||
been accounted for earlier. A file page will be accounted for as Page Cache;
|
||||
it's mapped into the page tables of a process, duplicate accounting is carefully
|
||||
avoided. Page Cache pages are accounted at the time of add_to_page_cache().
|
||||
The corresponding routines that remove a page from the page tables or removes
|
||||
a page from Page Cache is used to decrement the accounting counters of the
|
||||
cgroup.
|
||||
All mapped anon pages (RSS) and cache pages (Page Cache) are accounted.
|
||||
(some pages which never be reclaimable and will not be on global LRU
|
||||
are not accounted. we just accounts pages under usual vm management.)
|
||||
|
||||
RSS pages are accounted at page_fault unless they've already been accounted
|
||||
for earlier. A file page will be accounted for as Page Cache when it's
|
||||
inserted into inode (radix-tree). While it's mapped into the page tables of
|
||||
processes, duplicate accounting is carefully avoided.
|
||||
|
||||
A RSS page is unaccounted when it's fully unmapped. A PageCache page is
|
||||
unaccounted when it's removed from radix-tree.
|
||||
|
||||
At page migration, accounting information is kept.
|
||||
|
||||
Note: we just account pages-on-lru because our purpose is to control amount
|
||||
of used pages. not-on-lru pages are tend to be out-of-control from vm view.
|
||||
|
||||
2.3 Shared Page Accounting
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -48,7 +48,7 @@ hooks, beyond what is already present, required to manage dynamic
|
|||
job placement on large systems.
|
||||
|
||||
Cpusets use the generic cgroup subsystem described in
|
||||
Documentation/cgroup.txt.
|
||||
Documentation/cgroups/cgroups.txt.
|
||||
|
||||
Requests by a task, using the sched_setaffinity(2) system call to
|
||||
include CPUs in its CPU affinity mask, and using the mbind(2) and
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -2571,6 +2571,9 @@ Your cooperation is appreciated.
|
|||
160 = /dev/usb/legousbtower0 1st USB Legotower device
|
||||
...
|
||||
175 = /dev/usb/legousbtower15 16th USB Legotower device
|
||||
176 = /dev/usb/usbtmc1 First USB TMC device
|
||||
...
|
||||
192 = /dev/usb/usbtmc16 16th USB TMC device
|
||||
240 = /dev/usb/dabusb0 First daubusb device
|
||||
...
|
||||
243 = /dev/usb/dabusb3 Fourth dabusb device
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -359,3 +359,11 @@ Why: The 2.6 kernel supports direct writing to ide CD drives, which
|
|||
eliminates the need for ide-scsi. The new method is more
|
||||
efficient in every way.
|
||||
Who: FUJITA Tomonori <fujita.tomonori@lab.ntt.co.jp>
|
||||
|
||||
---------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
What: i2c_attach_client(), i2c_detach_client(), i2c_driver->detach_client()
|
||||
When: 2.6.29 (ideally) or 2.6.30 (more likely)
|
||||
Why: Deprecated by the new (standard) device driver binding model. Use
|
||||
i2c_driver->probe() and ->remove() instead.
|
||||
Who: Jean Delvare <khali@linux-fr.org>
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -96,6 +96,11 @@ errors=remount-ro(*) Remount the filesystem read-only on an error.
|
|||
errors=continue Keep going on a filesystem error.
|
||||
errors=panic Panic and halt the machine if an error occurs.
|
||||
|
||||
data_err=ignore(*) Just print an error message if an error occurs
|
||||
in a file data buffer in ordered mode.
|
||||
data_err=abort Abort the journal if an error occurs in a file
|
||||
data buffer in ordered mode.
|
||||
|
||||
grpid Give objects the same group ID as their creator.
|
||||
bsdgroups
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -2,19 +2,24 @@
|
|||
Ext4 Filesystem
|
||||
===============
|
||||
|
||||
This is a development version of the ext4 filesystem, an advanced level
|
||||
of the ext3 filesystem which incorporates scalability and reliability
|
||||
enhancements for supporting large filesystems (64 bit) in keeping with
|
||||
increasing disk capacities and state-of-the-art feature requirements.
|
||||
Ext4 is an an advanced level of the ext3 filesystem which incorporates
|
||||
scalability and reliability enhancements for supporting large filesystems
|
||||
(64 bit) in keeping with increasing disk capacities and state-of-the-art
|
||||
feature requirements.
|
||||
|
||||
Mailing list: linux-ext4@vger.kernel.org
|
||||
Mailing list: linux-ext4@vger.kernel.org
|
||||
Web site: http://ext4.wiki.kernel.org
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
1. Quick usage instructions:
|
||||
===========================
|
||||
|
||||
Note: More extensive information for getting started with ext4 can be
|
||||
found at the ext4 wiki site at the URL:
|
||||
http://ext4.wiki.kernel.org/index.php/Ext4_Howto
|
||||
|
||||
- Compile and install the latest version of e2fsprogs (as of this
|
||||
writing version 1.41) from:
|
||||
writing version 1.41.3) from:
|
||||
|
||||
http://sourceforge.net/project/showfiles.php?group_id=2406
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -36,11 +41,9 @@ Mailing list: linux-ext4@vger.kernel.org
|
|||
|
||||
# mke2fs -t ext4 /dev/hda1
|
||||
|
||||
Or configure an existing ext3 filesystem to support extents and set
|
||||
the test_fs flag to indicate that it's ok for an in-development
|
||||
filesystem to touch this filesystem:
|
||||
Or to configure an existing ext3 filesystem to support extents:
|
||||
|
||||
# tune2fs -O extents -E test_fs /dev/hda1
|
||||
# tune2fs -O extents /dev/hda1
|
||||
|
||||
If the filesystem was created with 128 byte inodes, it can be
|
||||
converted to use 256 byte for greater efficiency via:
|
||||
|
@ -104,8 +107,8 @@ exist yet so I'm not sure they're in the near-term roadmap.
|
|||
The big performance win will come with mballoc, delalloc and flex_bg
|
||||
grouping of bitmaps and inode tables. Some test results available here:
|
||||
|
||||
- http://www.bullopensource.org/ext4/20080530/ffsb-write-2.6.26-rc2.html
|
||||
- http://www.bullopensource.org/ext4/20080530/ffsb-readwrite-2.6.26-rc2.html
|
||||
- http://www.bullopensource.org/ext4/20080818-ffsb/ffsb-write-2.6.27-rc1.html
|
||||
- http://www.bullopensource.org/ext4/20080818-ffsb/ffsb-readwrite-2.6.27-rc1.html
|
||||
|
||||
3. Options
|
||||
==========
|
||||
|
@ -214,9 +217,6 @@ noreservation
|
|||
bsddf (*) Make 'df' act like BSD.
|
||||
minixdf Make 'df' act like Minix.
|
||||
|
||||
check=none Don't do extra checking of bitmaps on mount.
|
||||
nocheck
|
||||
|
||||
debug Extra debugging information is sent to syslog.
|
||||
|
||||
errors=remount-ro(*) Remount the filesystem read-only on an error.
|
||||
|
@ -253,8 +253,6 @@ nobh (a) cache disk block mapping information
|
|||
"nobh" option tries to avoid associating buffer
|
||||
heads (supported only for "writeback" mode).
|
||||
|
||||
mballoc (*) Use the multiple block allocator for block allocation
|
||||
nomballoc disabled multiple block allocator for block allocation.
|
||||
stripe=n Number of filesystem blocks that mballoc will try
|
||||
to use for allocation size and alignment. For RAID5/6
|
||||
systems this should be the number of data
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -1384,15 +1384,18 @@ causes the kernel to prefer to reclaim dentries and inodes.
|
|||
dirty_background_ratio
|
||||
----------------------
|
||||
|
||||
Contains, as a percentage of total system memory, the number of pages at which
|
||||
the pdflush background writeback daemon will start writing out dirty data.
|
||||
Contains, as a percentage of the dirtyable system memory (free pages + mapped
|
||||
pages + file cache, not including locked pages and HugePages), the number of
|
||||
pages at which the pdflush background writeback daemon will start writing out
|
||||
dirty data.
|
||||
|
||||
dirty_ratio
|
||||
-----------------
|
||||
|
||||
Contains, as a percentage of total system memory, the number of pages at which
|
||||
a process which is generating disk writes will itself start writing out dirty
|
||||
data.
|
||||
Contains, as a percentage of the dirtyable system memory (free pages + mapped
|
||||
pages + file cache, not including locked pages and HugePages), the number of
|
||||
pages at which a process which is generating disk writes will itself start
|
||||
writing out dirty data.
|
||||
|
||||
dirty_writeback_centisecs
|
||||
-------------------------
|
||||
|
@ -2412,24 +2415,29 @@ will be dumped when the <pid> process is dumped. coredump_filter is a bitmask
|
|||
of memory types. If a bit of the bitmask is set, memory segments of the
|
||||
corresponding memory type are dumped, otherwise they are not dumped.
|
||||
|
||||
The following 4 memory types are supported:
|
||||
The following 7 memory types are supported:
|
||||
- (bit 0) anonymous private memory
|
||||
- (bit 1) anonymous shared memory
|
||||
- (bit 2) file-backed private memory
|
||||
- (bit 3) file-backed shared memory
|
||||
- (bit 4) ELF header pages in file-backed private memory areas (it is
|
||||
effective only if the bit 2 is cleared)
|
||||
- (bit 5) hugetlb private memory
|
||||
- (bit 6) hugetlb shared memory
|
||||
|
||||
Note that MMIO pages such as frame buffer are never dumped and vDSO pages
|
||||
are always dumped regardless of the bitmask status.
|
||||
|
||||
Default value of coredump_filter is 0x3; this means all anonymous memory
|
||||
segments are dumped.
|
||||
Note bit 0-4 doesn't effect any hugetlb memory. hugetlb memory are only
|
||||
effected by bit 5-6.
|
||||
|
||||
Default value of coredump_filter is 0x23; this means all anonymous memory
|
||||
segments and hugetlb private memory are dumped.
|
||||
|
||||
If you don't want to dump all shared memory segments attached to pid 1234,
|
||||
write 1 to the process's proc file.
|
||||
write 0x21 to the process's proc file.
|
||||
|
||||
$ echo 0x1 > /proc/1234/coredump_filter
|
||||
$ echo 0x21 > /proc/1234/coredump_filter
|
||||
|
||||
When a new process is created, the process inherits the bitmask status from its
|
||||
parent. It is useful to set up coredump_filter before the program runs.
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -86,6 +86,15 @@ norm_unmount (*) commit on unmount; the journal is committed
|
|||
fast_unmount do not commit on unmount; this option makes
|
||||
unmount faster, but the next mount slower
|
||||
because of the need to replay the journal.
|
||||
bulk_read read more in one go to take advantage of flash
|
||||
media that read faster sequentially
|
||||
no_bulk_read (*) do not bulk-read
|
||||
no_chk_data_crc skip checking of CRCs on data nodes in order to
|
||||
improve read performance. Use this option only
|
||||
if the flash media is highly reliable. The effect
|
||||
of this option is that corruption of the contents
|
||||
of a file can go unnoticed.
|
||||
chk_data_crc (*) do not skip checking CRCs on data nodes
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Quick usage instructions
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,76 @@
|
|||
Kernel driver adt7470
|
||||
=====================
|
||||
|
||||
Supported chips:
|
||||
* Analog Devices ADT7470
|
||||
Prefix: 'adt7470'
|
||||
Addresses scanned: I2C 0x2C, 0x2E, 0x2F
|
||||
Datasheet: Publicly available at the Analog Devices website
|
||||
|
||||
Author: Darrick J. Wong
|
||||
|
||||
Description
|
||||
-----------
|
||||
|
||||
This driver implements support for the Analog Devices ADT7470 chip. There may
|
||||
be other chips that implement this interface.
|
||||
|
||||
The ADT7470 uses the 2-wire interface compatible with the SMBus 2.0
|
||||
specification. Using an analog to digital converter it measures up to ten (10)
|
||||
external temperatures. It has four (4) 16-bit counters for measuring fan speed.
|
||||
There are four (4) PWM outputs that can be used to control fan speed.
|
||||
|
||||
A sophisticated control system for the PWM outputs is designed into the ADT7470
|
||||
that allows fan speed to be adjusted automatically based on any of the ten
|
||||
temperature sensors. Each PWM output is individually adjustable and
|
||||
programmable. Once configured, the ADT7470 will adjust the PWM outputs in
|
||||
response to the measured temperatures with further host intervention. This
|
||||
feature can also be disabled for manual control of the PWM's.
|
||||
|
||||
Each of the measured inputs (temperature, fan speed) has corresponding high/low
|
||||
limit values. The ADT7470 will signal an ALARM if any measured value exceeds
|
||||
either limit.
|
||||
|
||||
The ADT7470 DOES NOT sample all inputs continuously. A single pin on the
|
||||
ADT7470 is connected to a multitude of thermal diodes, but the chip must be
|
||||
instructed explicitly to read the multitude of diodes. If you want to use
|
||||
automatic fan control mode, you must manually read any of the temperature
|
||||
sensors or the fan control algorithm will not run. The chip WILL NOT DO THIS
|
||||
AUTOMATICALLY; this must be done from userspace. This may be a bug in the chip
|
||||
design, given that many other AD chips take care of this. The driver will not
|
||||
read the registers more often than once every 5 seconds. Further,
|
||||
configuration data is only read once per minute.
|
||||
|
||||
Special Features
|
||||
----------------
|
||||
|
||||
The ADT7470 has a 8-bit ADC and is capable of measuring temperatures with 1
|
||||
degC resolution.
|
||||
|
||||
The Analog Devices datasheet is very detailed and describes a procedure for
|
||||
determining an optimal configuration for the automatic PWM control.
|
||||
|
||||
Configuration Notes
|
||||
-------------------
|
||||
|
||||
Besides standard interfaces driver adds the following:
|
||||
|
||||
* PWM Control
|
||||
|
||||
* pwm#_auto_point1_pwm and pwm#_auto_point1_temp and
|
||||
* pwm#_auto_point2_pwm and pwm#_auto_point2_temp -
|
||||
|
||||
point1: Set the pwm speed at a lower temperature bound.
|
||||
point2: Set the pwm speed at a higher temperature bound.
|
||||
|
||||
The ADT7470 will scale the pwm between the lower and higher pwm speed when
|
||||
the temperature is between the two temperature boundaries. PWM values range
|
||||
from 0 (off) to 255 (full speed). Fan speed will be set to maximum when the
|
||||
temperature sensor associated with the PWM control exceeds
|
||||
pwm#_auto_point2_temp.
|
||||
|
||||
Notes
|
||||
-----
|
||||
|
||||
As stated above, the temperature inputs must be read periodically from
|
||||
userspace in order for the automatic pwm algorithm to run.
|
|
@ -136,10 +136,10 @@ once-only alarms.
|
|||
The IT87xx only updates its values each 1.5 seconds; reading it more often
|
||||
will do no harm, but will return 'old' values.
|
||||
|
||||
To change sensor N to a thermistor, 'echo 2 > tempN_type' where N is 1, 2,
|
||||
To change sensor N to a thermistor, 'echo 4 > tempN_type' where N is 1, 2,
|
||||
or 3. To change sensor N to a thermal diode, 'echo 3 > tempN_type'.
|
||||
Give 0 for unused sensor. Any other value is invalid. To configure this at
|
||||
startup, consult lm_sensors's /etc/sensors.conf. (2 = thermistor;
|
||||
startup, consult lm_sensors's /etc/sensors.conf. (4 = thermistor;
|
||||
3 = thermal diode)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -163,16 +163,6 @@ configured individually according to the following options.
|
|||
* pwm#_auto_pwm_min - this specifies the PWM value for temp#_auto_temp_off
|
||||
temperature. (PWM value from 0 to 255)
|
||||
|
||||
* pwm#_auto_pwm_freq - select base frequency of PWM output. You can select
|
||||
in range of 10.0 to 94.0 Hz in .1 Hz units.
|
||||
(Values 100 to 940).
|
||||
|
||||
The pwm#_auto_pwm_freq can be set to one of the following 8 values. Setting the
|
||||
frequency to a value not on this list, will result in the next higher frequency
|
||||
being selected. The actual device frequency may vary slightly from this
|
||||
specification as designed by the manufacturer. Consult the datasheet for more
|
||||
details. (PWM Frequency values: 100, 150, 230, 300, 380, 470, 620, 940)
|
||||
|
||||
* pwm#_auto_pwm_minctl - this flags selects for temp#_auto_temp_off temperature
|
||||
the bahaviour of fans. Write 1 to let fans spinning at
|
||||
pwm#_auto_pwm_min or write 0 to let them off.
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -65,11 +65,10 @@ The LM87 has four pins which can serve one of two possible functions,
|
|||
depending on the hardware configuration.
|
||||
|
||||
Some functions share pins, so not all functions are available at the same
|
||||
time. Which are depends on the hardware setup. This driver assumes that
|
||||
the BIOS configured the chip correctly. In that respect, it differs from
|
||||
the original driver (from lm_sensors for Linux 2.4), which would force the
|
||||
LM87 to an arbitrary, compile-time chosen mode, regardless of the actual
|
||||
chipset wiring.
|
||||
time. Which are depends on the hardware setup. This driver normally
|
||||
assumes that firmware configured the chip correctly. Where this is not
|
||||
the case, platform code must set the I2C client's platform_data to point
|
||||
to a u8 value to be written to the channel register.
|
||||
|
||||
For reference, here is the list of exclusive functions:
|
||||
- in0+in5 (default) or temp3
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -11,7 +11,7 @@ Supported chips:
|
|||
Prefix: 'lm99'
|
||||
Addresses scanned: I2C 0x4c and 0x4d
|
||||
Datasheet: Publicly available at the National Semiconductor website
|
||||
http://www.national.com/pf/LM/LM89.html
|
||||
http://www.national.com/mpf/LM/LM89.html
|
||||
* National Semiconductor LM99
|
||||
Prefix: 'lm99'
|
||||
Addresses scanned: I2C 0x4c and 0x4d
|
||||
|
@ -21,18 +21,32 @@ Supported chips:
|
|||
Prefix: 'lm86'
|
||||
Addresses scanned: I2C 0x4c
|
||||
Datasheet: Publicly available at the National Semiconductor website
|
||||
http://www.national.com/pf/LM/LM86.html
|
||||
http://www.national.com/mpf/LM/LM86.html
|
||||
* Analog Devices ADM1032
|
||||
Prefix: 'adm1032'
|
||||
Addresses scanned: I2C 0x4c and 0x4d
|
||||
Datasheet: Publicly available at the Analog Devices website
|
||||
http://www.analog.com/en/prod/0,2877,ADM1032,00.html
|
||||
Datasheet: Publicly available at the ON Semiconductor website
|
||||
http://www.onsemi.com/PowerSolutions/product.do?id=ADM1032
|
||||
* Analog Devices ADT7461
|
||||
Prefix: 'adt7461'
|
||||
Addresses scanned: I2C 0x4c and 0x4d
|
||||
Datasheet: Publicly available at the Analog Devices website
|
||||
http://www.analog.com/en/prod/0,2877,ADT7461,00.html
|
||||
Note: Only if in ADM1032 compatibility mode
|
||||
Datasheet: Publicly available at the ON Semiconductor website
|
||||
http://www.onsemi.com/PowerSolutions/product.do?id=ADT7461
|
||||
* Maxim MAX6646
|
||||
Prefix: 'max6646'
|
||||
Addresses scanned: I2C 0x4d
|
||||
Datasheet: Publicly available at the Maxim website
|
||||
http://www.maxim-ic.com/quick_view2.cfm/qv_pk/3497
|
||||
* Maxim MAX6647
|
||||
Prefix: 'max6646'
|
||||
Addresses scanned: I2C 0x4e
|
||||
Datasheet: Publicly available at the Maxim website
|
||||
http://www.maxim-ic.com/quick_view2.cfm/qv_pk/3497
|
||||
* Maxim MAX6649
|
||||
Prefix: 'max6646'
|
||||
Addresses scanned: I2C 0x4c
|
||||
Datasheet: Publicly available at the Maxim website
|
||||
http://www.maxim-ic.com/quick_view2.cfm/qv_pk/3497
|
||||
* Maxim MAX6657
|
||||
Prefix: 'max6657'
|
||||
Addresses scanned: I2C 0x4c
|
||||
|
@ -70,25 +84,21 @@ Description
|
|||
|
||||
The LM90 is a digital temperature sensor. It senses its own temperature as
|
||||
well as the temperature of up to one external diode. It is compatible
|
||||
with many other devices such as the LM86, the LM89, the LM99, the ADM1032,
|
||||
the MAX6657, MAX6658, MAX6659, MAX6680 and the MAX6681 all of which are
|
||||
supported by this driver.
|
||||
with many other devices, many of which are supported by this driver.
|
||||
|
||||
Note that there is no easy way to differentiate between the MAX6657,
|
||||
MAX6658 and MAX6659 variants. The extra address and features of the
|
||||
MAX6659 are not supported by this driver. The MAX6680 and MAX6681 only
|
||||
differ in their pinout, therefore they obviously can't (and don't need to)
|
||||
be distinguished. Additionally, the ADT7461 is supported if found in
|
||||
ADM1032 compatibility mode.
|
||||
be distinguished.
|
||||
|
||||
The specificity of this family of chipsets over the ADM1021/LM84
|
||||
family is that it features critical limits with hysteresis, and an
|
||||
increased resolution of the remote temperature measurement.
|
||||
|
||||
The different chipsets of the family are not strictly identical, although
|
||||
very similar. This driver doesn't handle any specific feature for now,
|
||||
with the exception of SMBus PEC. For reference, here comes a non-exhaustive
|
||||
list of specific features:
|
||||
very similar. For reference, here comes a non-exhaustive list of specific
|
||||
features:
|
||||
|
||||
LM90:
|
||||
* Filter and alert configuration register at 0xBF.
|
||||
|
@ -114,9 +124,11 @@ ADT7461:
|
|||
* Lower resolution for remote temperature
|
||||
|
||||
MAX6657 and MAX6658:
|
||||
* Better local resolution
|
||||
* Remote sensor type selection
|
||||
|
||||
MAX6659:
|
||||
* Better local resolution
|
||||
* Selectable address
|
||||
* Second critical temperature limit
|
||||
* Remote sensor type selection
|
||||
|
@ -127,7 +139,8 @@ MAX6680 and MAX6681:
|
|||
|
||||
All temperature values are given in degrees Celsius. Resolution
|
||||
is 1.0 degree for the local temperature, 0.125 degree for the remote
|
||||
temperature.
|
||||
temperature, except for the MAX6657, MAX6658 and MAX6659 which have a
|
||||
resolution of 0.125 degree for both temperatures.
|
||||
|
||||
Each sensor has its own high and low limits, plus a critical limit.
|
||||
Additionally, there is a relative hysteresis value common to both critical
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -5,12 +5,7 @@ Supported chips:
|
|||
* National Semiconductor PC87360, PC87363, PC87364, PC87365 and PC87366
|
||||
Prefixes: 'pc87360', 'pc87363', 'pc87364', 'pc87365', 'pc87366'
|
||||
Addresses scanned: none, address read from Super I/O config space
|
||||
Datasheets:
|
||||
http://www.national.com/pf/PC/PC87360.html
|
||||
http://www.national.com/pf/PC/PC87363.html
|
||||
http://www.national.com/pf/PC/PC87364.html
|
||||
http://www.national.com/pf/PC/PC87365.html
|
||||
http://www.national.com/pf/PC/PC87366.html
|
||||
Datasheets: No longer available
|
||||
|
||||
Authors: Jean Delvare <khali@linux-fr.org>
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -5,7 +5,7 @@ Supported chips:
|
|||
* National Semiconductor PC87427
|
||||
Prefix: 'pc87427'
|
||||
Addresses scanned: none, address read from Super I/O config space
|
||||
Datasheet: http://www.winbond.com.tw/E-WINBONDHTM/partner/apc_007.html
|
||||
Datasheet: No longer available
|
||||
|
||||
Author: Jean Delvare <khali@linux-fr.org>
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -353,7 +353,7 @@ in6=255
|
|||
|
||||
# PWM
|
||||
|
||||
Additional info about PWM on the AS99127F (may apply to other Asus
|
||||
* Additional info about PWM on the AS99127F (may apply to other Asus
|
||||
chips as well) by Jean Delvare as of 2004-04-09:
|
||||
|
||||
AS99127F revision 2 seems to have two PWM registers at 0x59 and 0x5A,
|
||||
|
@ -396,7 +396,7 @@ Please contact us if you can figure out how it is supposed to work. As
|
|||
long as we don't know more, the w83781d driver doesn't handle PWM on
|
||||
AS99127F chips at all.
|
||||
|
||||
Additional info about PWM on the AS99127F rev.1 by Hector Martin:
|
||||
* Additional info about PWM on the AS99127F rev.1 by Hector Martin:
|
||||
|
||||
I've been fiddling around with the (in)famous 0x59 register and
|
||||
found out the following values do work as a form of coarse pwm:
|
||||
|
@ -418,3 +418,36 @@ change.
|
|||
My mobo is an ASUS A7V266-E. This behavior is similar to what I got
|
||||
with speedfan under Windows, where 0-15% would be off, 15-2x% (can't
|
||||
remember the exact value) would be 70% and higher would be full on.
|
||||
|
||||
* Additional info about PWM on the AS99127F rev.1 from lm-sensors
|
||||
ticket #2350:
|
||||
|
||||
I conducted some experiment on Asus P3B-F motherboard with AS99127F
|
||||
(Ver. 1).
|
||||
|
||||
I confirm that 0x59 register control the CPU_Fan Header on this
|
||||
motherboard, and 0x5a register control PWR_Fan.
|
||||
|
||||
In order to reduce the dependency of specific fan, the measurement is
|
||||
conducted with a digital scope without fan connected. I found out that
|
||||
P3B-F actually output variable DC voltage on fan header center pin,
|
||||
looks like PWM is filtered on this motherboard.
|
||||
|
||||
Here are some of measurements:
|
||||
|
||||
0x80 20 mV
|
||||
0x81 20 mV
|
||||
0x82 232 mV
|
||||
0x83 1.2 V
|
||||
0x84 2.31 V
|
||||
0x85 3.44 V
|
||||
0x86 4.62 V
|
||||
0x87 5.81 V
|
||||
0x88 7.01 V
|
||||
9x89 8.22 V
|
||||
0x8a 9.42 V
|
||||
0x8b 10.6 V
|
||||
0x8c 11.9 V
|
||||
0x8d 12.4 V
|
||||
0x8e 12.4 V
|
||||
0x8f 12.4 V
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -58,29 +58,35 @@ internal state that allows no clean access (Bank with ID register is not
|
|||
currently selected). If you know the address of the chip, use a 'force'
|
||||
parameter; this will put it into a more well-behaved state first.
|
||||
|
||||
The driver implements three temperature sensors, five fan rotation speed
|
||||
sensors, and ten voltage sensors.
|
||||
The driver implements three temperature sensors, ten voltage sensors,
|
||||
five fan rotation speed sensors and manual PWM control of each fan.
|
||||
|
||||
Temperatures are measured in degrees Celsius and measurement resolution is 1
|
||||
degC for temp1 and 0.5 degC for temp2 and temp3. An alarm is triggered when
|
||||
the temperature gets higher than the Overtemperature Shutdown value; it stays
|
||||
on until the temperature falls below the Hysteresis value.
|
||||
|
||||
Voltage sensors (also known as IN sensors) report their values in millivolts.
|
||||
An alarm is triggered if the voltage has crossed a programmable minimum
|
||||
or maximum limit.
|
||||
|
||||
Fan rotation speeds are reported in RPM (rotations per minute). An alarm is
|
||||
triggered if the rotation speed has dropped below a programmable limit. Fan
|
||||
readings can be divided by a programmable divider (1, 2, 4, 8, 16,
|
||||
32, 64 or 128 for all fans) to give the readings more range or accuracy.
|
||||
|
||||
Voltage sensors (also known as IN sensors) report their values in millivolts.
|
||||
An alarm is triggered if the voltage has crossed a programmable minimum
|
||||
or maximum limit.
|
||||
Each fan controlled is controlled by PWM. The PWM duty cycle can be read and
|
||||
set for each fan separately. Valid values range from 0 (stop) to 255 (full).
|
||||
PWM 1-3 support Thermal Cruise mode, in which the PWMs are automatically
|
||||
regulated to keep respectively temp 1-3 at a certain target temperature.
|
||||
See below for the description of the sysfs-interface.
|
||||
|
||||
The w83791d has a global bit used to enable beeping from the speaker when an
|
||||
alarm is triggered as well as a bitmask to enable or disable the beep for
|
||||
specific alarms. You need both the global beep enable bit and the
|
||||
corresponding beep bit to be on for a triggered alarm to sound a beep.
|
||||
|
||||
The sysfs interface to the gloabal enable is via the sysfs beep_enable file.
|
||||
The sysfs interface to the global enable is via the sysfs beep_enable file.
|
||||
This file is used for both legacy and new code.
|
||||
|
||||
The sysfs interface to the beep bitmask has migrated from the original legacy
|
||||
|
@ -105,6 +111,27 @@ going forward.
|
|||
The driver reads the hardware chip values at most once every three seconds.
|
||||
User mode code requesting values more often will receive cached values.
|
||||
|
||||
/sys files
|
||||
----------
|
||||
The sysfs-interface is documented in the 'sysfs-interface' file. Only
|
||||
chip-specific options are documented here.
|
||||
|
||||
pwm[1-3]_enable - this file controls mode of fan/temperature control for
|
||||
fan 1-3. Fan/PWM 4-5 only support manual mode.
|
||||
* 1 Manual mode
|
||||
* 2 Thermal Cruise mode
|
||||
* 3 Fan Speed Cruise mode (no further support)
|
||||
|
||||
temp[1-3]_target - defines the target temperature for Thermal Cruise mode.
|
||||
Unit: millidegree Celsius
|
||||
RW
|
||||
|
||||
temp[1-3]_tolerance - temperature tolerance for Thermal Cruise mode.
|
||||
Specifies an interval around the target temperature
|
||||
in which the fan speed is not changed.
|
||||
Unit: millidegree Celsius
|
||||
RW
|
||||
|
||||
Alarms bitmap vs. beep_mask bitmask
|
||||
------------------------------------
|
||||
For legacy code using the alarms and beep_mask files:
|
||||
|
@ -132,7 +159,3 @@ tart2 : alarms: 0x020000 beep_mask: 0x080000 <== mismatch
|
|||
tart3 : alarms: 0x040000 beep_mask: 0x100000 <== mismatch
|
||||
case_open : alarms: 0x001000 beep_mask: 0x001000
|
||||
global_enable: alarms: -------- beep_mask: 0x800000 (modified via beep_enable)
|
||||
|
||||
W83791D TODO:
|
||||
---------------
|
||||
Provide a patch for smart-fan control (still need appropriate motherboard/fans)
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -13,8 +13,9 @@ Supported adapters:
|
|||
* Intel 631xESB/632xESB (ESB2)
|
||||
* Intel 82801H (ICH8)
|
||||
* Intel 82801I (ICH9)
|
||||
* Intel Tolapai
|
||||
* Intel ICH10
|
||||
* Intel EP80579 (Tolapai)
|
||||
* Intel 82801JI (ICH10)
|
||||
* Intel PCH
|
||||
Datasheets: Publicly available at the Intel website
|
||||
|
||||
Authors:
|
||||
|
@ -32,7 +33,7 @@ Description
|
|||
-----------
|
||||
|
||||
The ICH (properly known as the 82801AA), ICH0 (82801AB), ICH2 (82801BA),
|
||||
ICH3 (82801CA/CAM) and later devices are Intel chips that are a part of
|
||||
ICH3 (82801CA/CAM) and later devices (PCH) are Intel chips that are a part of
|
||||
Intel's '810' chipset for Celeron-based PCs, '810E' chipset for
|
||||
Pentium-based PCs, '815E' chipset, and others.
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -1,160 +0,0 @@
|
|||
Revision 7, 2007-04-19
|
||||
Jean Delvare <khali@linux-fr.org>
|
||||
Greg KH <greg@kroah.com>
|
||||
|
||||
This is a guide on how to convert I2C chip drivers from Linux 2.4 to
|
||||
Linux 2.6. I have been using existing drivers (lm75, lm78) as examples.
|
||||
Then I converted a driver myself (lm83) and updated this document.
|
||||
Note that this guide is strongly oriented towards hardware monitoring
|
||||
drivers. Many points are still valid for other type of drivers, but
|
||||
others may be irrelevant.
|
||||
|
||||
There are two sets of points below. The first set concerns technical
|
||||
changes. The second set concerns coding policy. Both are mandatory.
|
||||
|
||||
Although reading this guide will help you porting drivers, I suggest
|
||||
you keep an eye on an already ported driver while porting your own
|
||||
driver. This will help you a lot understanding what this guide
|
||||
exactly means. Choose the chip driver that is the more similar to
|
||||
yours for best results.
|
||||
|
||||
Technical changes:
|
||||
|
||||
* [Driver type] Any driver that was relying on i2c-isa has to be
|
||||
converted to a proper isa, platform or pci driver. This is not
|
||||
covered by this guide.
|
||||
|
||||
* [Includes] Get rid of "version.h" and <linux/i2c-proc.h>.
|
||||
Includes typically look like that:
|
||||
#include <linux/module.h>
|
||||
#include <linux/init.h>
|
||||
#include <linux/slab.h>
|
||||
#include <linux/jiffies.h>
|
||||
#include <linux/i2c.h>
|
||||
#include <linux/hwmon.h> /* for hardware monitoring drivers */
|
||||
#include <linux/hwmon-sysfs.h>
|
||||
#include <linux/hwmon-vid.h> /* if you need VRM support */
|
||||
#include <linux/err.h> /* for class registration */
|
||||
Please respect this inclusion order. Some extra headers may be
|
||||
required for a given driver (e.g. "lm75.h").
|
||||
|
||||
* [Addresses] SENSORS_I2C_END becomes I2C_CLIENT_END, ISA addresses
|
||||
are no more handled by the i2c core. Address ranges are no more
|
||||
supported either, define each individual address separately.
|
||||
SENSORS_INSMOD_<n> becomes I2C_CLIENT_INSMOD_<n>.
|
||||
|
||||
* [Client data] Get rid of sysctl_id. Try using standard names for
|
||||
register values (for example, temp_os becomes temp_max). You're
|
||||
still relatively free here, but you *have* to follow the standard
|
||||
names for sysfs files (see the Sysctl section below).
|
||||
|
||||
* [Function prototypes] The detect functions loses its flags
|
||||
parameter. Sysctl (e.g. lm75_temp) and miscellaneous functions
|
||||
are off the list of prototypes. This usually leaves five
|
||||
prototypes:
|
||||
static int lm75_attach_adapter(struct i2c_adapter *adapter);
|
||||
static int lm75_detect(struct i2c_adapter *adapter, int address,
|
||||
int kind);
|
||||
static void lm75_init_client(struct i2c_client *client);
|
||||
static int lm75_detach_client(struct i2c_client *client);
|
||||
static struct lm75_data lm75_update_device(struct device *dev);
|
||||
|
||||
* [Sysctl] All sysctl stuff is of course gone (defines, ctl_table
|
||||
and functions). Instead, you have to define show and set functions for
|
||||
each sysfs file. Only define set for writable values. Take a look at an
|
||||
existing 2.6 driver for details (it87 for example). Don't forget
|
||||
to define the attributes for each file (this is that step that
|
||||
links callback functions). Use the file names specified in
|
||||
Documentation/hwmon/sysfs-interface for the individual files. Also
|
||||
convert the units these files read and write to the specified ones.
|
||||
If you need to add a new type of file, please discuss it on the
|
||||
sensors mailing list <lm-sensors@lm-sensors.org> by providing a
|
||||
patch to the Documentation/hwmon/sysfs-interface file.
|
||||
|
||||
* [Attach] The attach function should make sure that the adapter's
|
||||
class has I2C_CLASS_HWMON (or whatever class is suitable for your
|
||||
driver), using the following construct:
|
||||
if (!(adapter->class & I2C_CLASS_HWMON))
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
Call i2c_probe() instead of i2c_detect().
|
||||
|
||||
* [Detect] As mentioned earlier, the flags parameter is gone.
|
||||
The type_name and client_name strings are replaced by a single
|
||||
name string, which will be filled with a lowercase, short string.
|
||||
The labels used for error paths are reduced to the number needed.
|
||||
It is advised that the labels are given descriptive names such as
|
||||
exit and exit_free. Don't forget to properly set err before
|
||||
jumping to error labels. By the way, labels should be left-aligned.
|
||||
Use kzalloc instead of kmalloc.
|
||||
Use i2c_set_clientdata to set the client data (as opposed to
|
||||
a direct access to client->data).
|
||||
Use strlcpy instead of strcpy or snprintf to copy the client name.
|
||||
Replace the sysctl directory registration by calls to
|
||||
device_create_file. Move the driver initialization before any
|
||||
sysfs file creation.
|
||||
Register the client with the hwmon class (using hwmon_device_register)
|
||||
if applicable.
|
||||
Drop client->id.
|
||||
Drop any 24RF08 corruption prevention you find, as this is now done
|
||||
at the i2c-core level, and doing it twice voids it.
|
||||
Don't add I2C_CLIENT_ALLOW_USE to client->flags, it's the default now.
|
||||
|
||||
* [Init] Limits must not be set by the driver (can be done later in
|
||||
user-space). Chip should not be reset default (although a module
|
||||
parameter may be used to force it), and initialization should be
|
||||
limited to the strictly necessary steps.
|
||||
|
||||
* [Detach] Remove the call to i2c_deregister_entry. Do not log an
|
||||
error message if i2c_detach_client fails, as i2c-core will now do
|
||||
it for you.
|
||||
Unregister from the hwmon class if applicable.
|
||||
|
||||
* [Update] The function prototype changed, it is now
|
||||
passed a device structure, which you have to convert to a client
|
||||
using to_i2c_client(dev). The update function should return a
|
||||
pointer to the client data.
|
||||
Don't access client->data directly, use i2c_get_clientdata(client)
|
||||
instead.
|
||||
Use time_after() instead of direct jiffies comparison.
|
||||
|
||||
* [Interface] Make sure there is a MODULE_LICENSE() line, at the bottom
|
||||
of the file (after MODULE_AUTHOR() and MODULE_DESCRIPTION(), in this
|
||||
order).
|
||||
|
||||
* [Driver] The flags field of the i2c_driver structure is gone.
|
||||
I2C_DF_NOTIFY is now the default behavior.
|
||||
The i2c_driver structure has a driver member, which is itself a
|
||||
structure, those name member should be initialized to a driver name
|
||||
string. i2c_driver itself has no name member anymore.
|
||||
|
||||
* [Driver model] Instead of shutdown or reboot notifiers, provide a
|
||||
shutdown() method in your driver.
|
||||
|
||||
* [Power management] Use the driver model suspend() and resume()
|
||||
callbacks instead of the obsolete pm_register() calls.
|
||||
|
||||
Coding policy:
|
||||
|
||||
* [Copyright] Use (C), not (c), for copyright.
|
||||
|
||||
* [Debug/log] Get rid of #ifdef DEBUG/#endif constructs whenever you
|
||||
can. Calls to printk for debugging purposes are replaced by calls to
|
||||
dev_dbg where possible, else to pr_debug. Here is an example of how
|
||||
to call it (taken from lm75_detect):
|
||||
dev_dbg(&client->dev, "Starting lm75 update\n");
|
||||
Replace other printk calls with the dev_info, dev_err or dev_warn
|
||||
function, as appropriate.
|
||||
|
||||
* [Constants] Constants defines (registers, conversions) should be
|
||||
aligned. This greatly improves readability.
|
||||
Alignments are achieved by the means of tabs, not spaces. Remember
|
||||
that tabs are set to 8 in the Linux kernel code.
|
||||
|
||||
* [Layout] Avoid extra empty lines between comments and what they
|
||||
comment. Respect the coding style (see Documentation/CodingStyle),
|
||||
in particular when it comes to placing curly braces.
|
||||
|
||||
* [Comments] Make sure that no comment refers to a file that isn't
|
||||
part of the Linux source tree (typically doc/chips/<chip name>),
|
||||
and that remaining comments still match the code. Merging comment
|
||||
lines when possible is encouraged.
|
|
@ -10,23 +10,21 @@ General remarks
|
|||
===============
|
||||
|
||||
Try to keep the kernel namespace as clean as possible. The best way to
|
||||
do this is to use a unique prefix for all global symbols. This is
|
||||
do this is to use a unique prefix for all global symbols. This is
|
||||
especially important for exported symbols, but it is a good idea to do
|
||||
it for non-exported symbols too. We will use the prefix `foo_' in this
|
||||
tutorial, and `FOO_' for preprocessor variables.
|
||||
tutorial.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
The driver structure
|
||||
====================
|
||||
|
||||
Usually, you will implement a single driver structure, and instantiate
|
||||
all clients from it. Remember, a driver structure contains general access
|
||||
all clients from it. Remember, a driver structure contains general access
|
||||
routines, and should be zero-initialized except for fields with data you
|
||||
provide. A client structure holds device-specific information like the
|
||||
driver model device node, and its I2C address.
|
||||
|
||||
/* iff driver uses driver model ("new style") binding model: */
|
||||
|
||||
static struct i2c_device_id foo_idtable[] = {
|
||||
{ "foo", my_id_for_foo },
|
||||
{ "bar", my_id_for_bar },
|
||||
|
@ -40,7 +38,6 @@ static struct i2c_driver foo_driver = {
|
|||
.name = "foo",
|
||||
},
|
||||
|
||||
/* iff driver uses driver model ("new style") binding model: */
|
||||
.id_table = foo_ids,
|
||||
.probe = foo_probe,
|
||||
.remove = foo_remove,
|
||||
|
@ -49,24 +46,19 @@ static struct i2c_driver foo_driver = {
|
|||
.detect = foo_detect,
|
||||
.address_data = &addr_data,
|
||||
|
||||
/* else, driver uses "legacy" binding model: */
|
||||
.attach_adapter = foo_attach_adapter,
|
||||
.detach_client = foo_detach_client,
|
||||
|
||||
/* these may be used regardless of the driver binding model */
|
||||
.shutdown = foo_shutdown, /* optional */
|
||||
.suspend = foo_suspend, /* optional */
|
||||
.resume = foo_resume, /* optional */
|
||||
.command = foo_command, /* optional */
|
||||
.command = foo_command, /* optional, deprecated */
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
The name field is the driver name, and must not contain spaces. It
|
||||
should match the module name (if the driver can be compiled as a module),
|
||||
although you can use MODULE_ALIAS (passing "foo" in this example) to add
|
||||
another name for the module. If the driver name doesn't match the module
|
||||
name, the module won't be automatically loaded (hotplug/coldplug).
|
||||
|
||||
All other fields are for call-back functions which will be explained
|
||||
All other fields are for call-back functions which will be explained
|
||||
below.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -74,34 +66,13 @@ Extra client data
|
|||
=================
|
||||
|
||||
Each client structure has a special `data' field that can point to any
|
||||
structure at all. You should use this to keep device-specific data,
|
||||
especially in drivers that handle multiple I2C or SMBUS devices. You
|
||||
do not always need this, but especially for `sensors' drivers, it can
|
||||
be very useful.
|
||||
structure at all. You should use this to keep device-specific data.
|
||||
|
||||
/* store the value */
|
||||
void i2c_set_clientdata(struct i2c_client *client, void *data);
|
||||
|
||||
/* retrieve the value */
|
||||
void *i2c_get_clientdata(struct i2c_client *client);
|
||||
|
||||
An example structure is below.
|
||||
|
||||
struct foo_data {
|
||||
struct i2c_client client;
|
||||
enum chips type; /* To keep the chips type for `sensors' drivers. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Because the i2c bus is slow, it is often useful to cache the read
|
||||
information of a chip for some time (for example, 1 or 2 seconds).
|
||||
It depends of course on the device whether this is really worthwhile
|
||||
or even sensible. */
|
||||
struct mutex update_lock; /* When we are reading lots of information,
|
||||
another process should not update the
|
||||
below information */
|
||||
char valid; /* != 0 if the following fields are valid. */
|
||||
unsigned long last_updated; /* In jiffies */
|
||||
/* Add the read information here too */
|
||||
};
|
||||
void *i2c_get_clientdata(const struct i2c_client *client);
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Accessing the client
|
||||
|
@ -109,11 +80,9 @@ Accessing the client
|
|||
|
||||
Let's say we have a valid client structure. At some time, we will need
|
||||
to gather information from the client, or write new information to the
|
||||
client. How we will export this information to user-space is less
|
||||
important at this moment (perhaps we do not need to do this at all for
|
||||
some obscure clients). But we need generic reading and writing routines.
|
||||
client.
|
||||
|
||||
I have found it useful to define foo_read and foo_write function for this.
|
||||
I have found it useful to define foo_read and foo_write functions for this.
|
||||
For some cases, it will be easier to call the i2c functions directly,
|
||||
but many chips have some kind of register-value idea that can easily
|
||||
be encapsulated.
|
||||
|
@ -121,33 +90,33 @@ be encapsulated.
|
|||
The below functions are simple examples, and should not be copied
|
||||
literally.
|
||||
|
||||
int foo_read_value(struct i2c_client *client, u8 reg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (reg < 0x10) /* byte-sized register */
|
||||
return i2c_smbus_read_byte_data(client,reg);
|
||||
else /* word-sized register */
|
||||
return i2c_smbus_read_word_data(client,reg);
|
||||
}
|
||||
int foo_read_value(struct i2c_client *client, u8 reg)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (reg < 0x10) /* byte-sized register */
|
||||
return i2c_smbus_read_byte_data(client, reg);
|
||||
else /* word-sized register */
|
||||
return i2c_smbus_read_word_data(client, reg);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
int foo_write_value(struct i2c_client *client, u8 reg, u16 value)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (reg == 0x10) /* Impossible to write - driver error! */ {
|
||||
return -1;
|
||||
else if (reg < 0x10) /* byte-sized register */
|
||||
return i2c_smbus_write_byte_data(client,reg,value);
|
||||
else /* word-sized register */
|
||||
return i2c_smbus_write_word_data(client,reg,value);
|
||||
}
|
||||
int foo_write_value(struct i2c_client *client, u8 reg, u16 value)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (reg == 0x10) /* Impossible to write - driver error! */
|
||||
return -EINVAL;
|
||||
else if (reg < 0x10) /* byte-sized register */
|
||||
return i2c_smbus_write_byte_data(client, reg, value);
|
||||
else /* word-sized register */
|
||||
return i2c_smbus_write_word_data(client, reg, value);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Probing and attaching
|
||||
=====================
|
||||
|
||||
The Linux I2C stack was originally written to support access to hardware
|
||||
monitoring chips on PC motherboards, and thus it embeds some assumptions
|
||||
that are more appropriate to SMBus (and PCs) than to I2C. One of these
|
||||
assumptions is that most adapters and devices drivers support the SMBUS_QUICK
|
||||
protocol to probe device presence. Another is that devices and their drivers
|
||||
monitoring chips on PC motherboards, and thus used to embed some assumptions
|
||||
that were more appropriate to SMBus (and PCs) than to I2C. One of these
|
||||
assumptions was that most adapters and devices drivers support the SMBUS_QUICK
|
||||
protocol to probe device presence. Another was that devices and their drivers
|
||||
can be sufficiently configured using only such probe primitives.
|
||||
|
||||
As Linux and its I2C stack became more widely used in embedded systems
|
||||
|
@ -164,6 +133,9 @@ since the "legacy" model requires drivers to create "i2c_client" device
|
|||
objects after SMBus style probing, while the Linux driver model expects
|
||||
drivers to be given such device objects in their probe() routines.
|
||||
|
||||
The legacy model is deprecated now and will soon be removed, so we no
|
||||
longer document it here.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Standard Driver Model Binding ("New Style")
|
||||
-------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
@ -193,8 +165,8 @@ matches the device's name. It is passed the entry that was matched so
|
|||
the driver knows which one in the table matched.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Device Creation (Standard driver model)
|
||||
---------------------------------------
|
||||
Device Creation
|
||||
---------------
|
||||
|
||||
If you know for a fact that an I2C device is connected to a given I2C bus,
|
||||
you can instantiate that device by simply filling an i2c_board_info
|
||||
|
@ -221,8 +193,8 @@ in the I2C bus driver. You may want to save the returned i2c_client
|
|||
reference for later use.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Device Detection (Standard driver model)
|
||||
----------------------------------------
|
||||
Device Detection
|
||||
----------------
|
||||
|
||||
Sometimes you do not know in advance which I2C devices are connected to
|
||||
a given I2C bus. This is for example the case of hardware monitoring
|
||||
|
@ -246,8 +218,8 @@ otherwise misdetections are likely to occur and things can get wrong
|
|||
quickly.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Device Deletion (Standard driver model)
|
||||
---------------------------------------
|
||||
Device Deletion
|
||||
---------------
|
||||
|
||||
Each I2C device which has been created using i2c_new_device() or
|
||||
i2c_new_probed_device() can be unregistered by calling
|
||||
|
@ -256,264 +228,37 @@ called automatically before the underlying I2C bus itself is removed, as a
|
|||
device can't survive its parent in the device driver model.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Legacy Driver Binding Model
|
||||
---------------------------
|
||||
Initializing the driver
|
||||
=======================
|
||||
|
||||
Most i2c devices can be present on several i2c addresses; for some this
|
||||
is determined in hardware (by soldering some chip pins to Vcc or Ground),
|
||||
for others this can be changed in software (by writing to specific client
|
||||
registers). Some devices are usually on a specific address, but not always;
|
||||
and some are even more tricky. So you will probably need to scan several
|
||||
i2c addresses for your clients, and do some sort of detection to see
|
||||
whether it is actually a device supported by your driver.
|
||||
When the kernel is booted, or when your foo driver module is inserted,
|
||||
you have to do some initializing. Fortunately, just registering the
|
||||
driver module is usually enough.
|
||||
|
||||
To give the user a maximum of possibilities, some default module parameters
|
||||
are defined to help determine what addresses are scanned. Several macros
|
||||
are defined in i2c.h to help you support them, as well as a generic
|
||||
detection algorithm.
|
||||
static int __init foo_init(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return i2c_add_driver(&foo_driver);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
You do not have to use this parameter interface; but don't try to use
|
||||
function i2c_probe() if you don't.
|
||||
static void __exit foo_cleanup(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
i2c_del_driver(&foo_driver);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Substitute your own name and email address */
|
||||
MODULE_AUTHOR("Frodo Looijaard <frodol@dds.nl>"
|
||||
MODULE_DESCRIPTION("Driver for Barf Inc. Foo I2C devices");
|
||||
|
||||
Probing classes (Legacy model)
|
||||
------------------------------
|
||||
/* a few non-GPL license types are also allowed */
|
||||
MODULE_LICENSE("GPL");
|
||||
|
||||
All parameters are given as lists of unsigned 16-bit integers. Lists are
|
||||
terminated by I2C_CLIENT_END.
|
||||
The following lists are used internally:
|
||||
module_init(foo_init);
|
||||
module_exit(foo_cleanup);
|
||||
|
||||
normal_i2c: filled in by the module writer.
|
||||
A list of I2C addresses which should normally be examined.
|
||||
probe: insmod parameter.
|
||||
A list of pairs. The first value is a bus number (-1 for any I2C bus),
|
||||
the second is the address. These addresses are also probed, as if they
|
||||
were in the 'normal' list.
|
||||
ignore: insmod parameter.
|
||||
A list of pairs. The first value is a bus number (-1 for any I2C bus),
|
||||
the second is the I2C address. These addresses are never probed.
|
||||
This parameter overrules the 'normal_i2c' list only.
|
||||
force: insmod parameter.
|
||||
A list of pairs. The first value is a bus number (-1 for any I2C bus),
|
||||
the second is the I2C address. A device is blindly assumed to be on
|
||||
the given address, no probing is done.
|
||||
|
||||
Additionally, kind-specific force lists may optionally be defined if
|
||||
the driver supports several chip kinds. They are grouped in a
|
||||
NULL-terminated list of pointers named forces, those first element if the
|
||||
generic force list mentioned above. Each additional list correspond to an
|
||||
insmod parameter of the form force_<kind>.
|
||||
|
||||
Fortunately, as a module writer, you just have to define the `normal_i2c'
|
||||
parameter. The complete declaration could look like this:
|
||||
|
||||
/* Scan 0x4c to 0x4f */
|
||||
static const unsigned short normal_i2c[] = { 0x4c, 0x4d, 0x4e, 0x4f,
|
||||
I2C_CLIENT_END };
|
||||
|
||||
/* Magic definition of all other variables and things */
|
||||
I2C_CLIENT_INSMOD;
|
||||
/* Or, if your driver supports, say, 2 kind of devices: */
|
||||
I2C_CLIENT_INSMOD_2(foo, bar);
|
||||
|
||||
If you use the multi-kind form, an enum will be defined for you:
|
||||
enum chips { any_chip, foo, bar, ... }
|
||||
You can then (and certainly should) use it in the driver code.
|
||||
|
||||
Note that you *have* to call the defined variable `normal_i2c',
|
||||
without any prefix!
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Attaching to an adapter (Legacy model)
|
||||
--------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
Whenever a new adapter is inserted, or for all adapters if the driver is
|
||||
being registered, the callback attach_adapter() is called. Now is the
|
||||
time to determine what devices are present on the adapter, and to register
|
||||
a client for each of them.
|
||||
|
||||
The attach_adapter callback is really easy: we just call the generic
|
||||
detection function. This function will scan the bus for us, using the
|
||||
information as defined in the lists explained above. If a device is
|
||||
detected at a specific address, another callback is called.
|
||||
|
||||
int foo_attach_adapter(struct i2c_adapter *adapter)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return i2c_probe(adapter,&addr_data,&foo_detect_client);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
Remember, structure `addr_data' is defined by the macros explained above,
|
||||
so you do not have to define it yourself.
|
||||
|
||||
The i2c_probe function will call the foo_detect_client
|
||||
function only for those i2c addresses that actually have a device on
|
||||
them (unless a `force' parameter was used). In addition, addresses that
|
||||
are already in use (by some other registered client) are skipped.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
The detect client function (Legacy model)
|
||||
-----------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
The detect client function is called by i2c_probe. The `kind' parameter
|
||||
contains -1 for a probed detection, 0 for a forced detection, or a positive
|
||||
number for a forced detection with a chip type forced.
|
||||
|
||||
Returning an error different from -ENODEV in a detect function will cause
|
||||
the detection to stop: other addresses and adapters won't be scanned.
|
||||
This should only be done on fatal or internal errors, such as a memory
|
||||
shortage or i2c_attach_client failing.
|
||||
|
||||
For now, you can ignore the `flags' parameter. It is there for future use.
|
||||
|
||||
int foo_detect_client(struct i2c_adapter *adapter, int address,
|
||||
int kind)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int err = 0;
|
||||
int i;
|
||||
struct i2c_client *client;
|
||||
struct foo_data *data;
|
||||
const char *name = "";
|
||||
|
||||
/* Let's see whether this adapter can support what we need.
|
||||
Please substitute the things you need here! */
|
||||
if (!i2c_check_functionality(adapter,I2C_FUNC_SMBUS_WORD_DATA |
|
||||
I2C_FUNC_SMBUS_WRITE_BYTE))
|
||||
goto ERROR0;
|
||||
|
||||
/* OK. For now, we presume we have a valid client. We now create the
|
||||
client structure, even though we cannot fill it completely yet.
|
||||
But it allows us to access several i2c functions safely */
|
||||
|
||||
if (!(data = kzalloc(sizeof(struct foo_data), GFP_KERNEL))) {
|
||||
err = -ENOMEM;
|
||||
goto ERROR0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
client = &data->client;
|
||||
i2c_set_clientdata(client, data);
|
||||
|
||||
client->addr = address;
|
||||
client->adapter = adapter;
|
||||
client->driver = &foo_driver;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Now, we do the remaining detection. If no `force' parameter is used. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* First, the generic detection (if any), that is skipped if any force
|
||||
parameter was used. */
|
||||
if (kind < 0) {
|
||||
/* The below is of course bogus */
|
||||
if (foo_read(client, FOO_REG_GENERIC) != FOO_GENERIC_VALUE)
|
||||
goto ERROR1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Next, specific detection. This is especially important for `sensors'
|
||||
devices. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Determine the chip type. Not needed if a `force_CHIPTYPE' parameter
|
||||
was used. */
|
||||
if (kind <= 0) {
|
||||
i = foo_read(client, FOO_REG_CHIPTYPE);
|
||||
if (i == FOO_TYPE_1)
|
||||
kind = chip1; /* As defined in the enum */
|
||||
else if (i == FOO_TYPE_2)
|
||||
kind = chip2;
|
||||
else {
|
||||
printk("foo: Ignoring 'force' parameter for unknown chip at "
|
||||
"adapter %d, address 0x%02x\n",i2c_adapter_id(adapter),address);
|
||||
goto ERROR1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Now set the type and chip names */
|
||||
if (kind == chip1) {
|
||||
name = "chip1";
|
||||
} else if (kind == chip2) {
|
||||
name = "chip2";
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Fill in the remaining client fields. */
|
||||
strlcpy(client->name, name, I2C_NAME_SIZE);
|
||||
data->type = kind;
|
||||
mutex_init(&data->update_lock); /* Only if you use this field */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Any other initializations in data must be done here too. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* This function can write default values to the client registers, if
|
||||
needed. */
|
||||
foo_init_client(client);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Tell the i2c layer a new client has arrived */
|
||||
if ((err = i2c_attach_client(client)))
|
||||
goto ERROR1;
|
||||
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
|
||||
/* OK, this is not exactly good programming practice, usually. But it is
|
||||
very code-efficient in this case. */
|
||||
|
||||
ERROR1:
|
||||
kfree(data);
|
||||
ERROR0:
|
||||
return err;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Removing the client (Legacy model)
|
||||
==================================
|
||||
|
||||
The detach_client call back function is called when a client should be
|
||||
removed. It may actually fail, but only when panicking. This code is
|
||||
much simpler than the attachment code, fortunately!
|
||||
|
||||
int foo_detach_client(struct i2c_client *client)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int err;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Try to detach the client from i2c space */
|
||||
if ((err = i2c_detach_client(client)))
|
||||
return err;
|
||||
|
||||
kfree(i2c_get_clientdata(client));
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Initializing the module or kernel
|
||||
=================================
|
||||
|
||||
When the kernel is booted, or when your foo driver module is inserted,
|
||||
you have to do some initializing. Fortunately, just attaching (registering)
|
||||
the driver module is usually enough.
|
||||
|
||||
static int __init foo_init(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int res;
|
||||
|
||||
if ((res = i2c_add_driver(&foo_driver))) {
|
||||
printk("foo: Driver registration failed, module not inserted.\n");
|
||||
return res;
|
||||
}
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static void __exit foo_cleanup(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
i2c_del_driver(&foo_driver);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* Substitute your own name and email address */
|
||||
MODULE_AUTHOR("Frodo Looijaard <frodol@dds.nl>"
|
||||
MODULE_DESCRIPTION("Driver for Barf Inc. Foo I2C devices");
|
||||
|
||||
/* a few non-GPL license types are also allowed */
|
||||
MODULE_LICENSE("GPL");
|
||||
|
||||
module_init(foo_init);
|
||||
module_exit(foo_cleanup);
|
||||
|
||||
Note that some functions are marked by `__init', and some data structures
|
||||
by `__initdata'. These functions and structures can be removed after
|
||||
kernel booting (or module loading) is completed.
|
||||
Note that some functions are marked by `__init'. These functions can
|
||||
be removed after kernel booting (or module loading) is completed.
|
||||
Likewise, functions marked by `__exit' are dropped by the compiler when
|
||||
the code is built into the kernel, as they would never be called.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Power Management
|
||||
|
@ -548,33 +293,35 @@ Command function
|
|||
|
||||
A generic ioctl-like function call back is supported. You will seldom
|
||||
need this, and its use is deprecated anyway, so newer design should not
|
||||
use it. Set it to NULL.
|
||||
use it.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Sending and receiving
|
||||
=====================
|
||||
|
||||
If you want to communicate with your device, there are several functions
|
||||
to do this. You can find all of them in i2c.h.
|
||||
to do this. You can find all of them in <linux/i2c.h>.
|
||||
|
||||
If you can choose between plain i2c communication and SMBus level
|
||||
communication, please use the last. All adapters understand SMBus level
|
||||
commands, but only some of them understand plain i2c!
|
||||
If you can choose between plain I2C communication and SMBus level
|
||||
communication, please use the latter. All adapters understand SMBus level
|
||||
commands, but only some of them understand plain I2C!
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Plain i2c communication
|
||||
Plain I2C communication
|
||||
-----------------------
|
||||
|
||||
extern int i2c_master_send(struct i2c_client *,const char* ,int);
|
||||
extern int i2c_master_recv(struct i2c_client *,char* ,int);
|
||||
int i2c_master_send(struct i2c_client *client, const char *buf,
|
||||
int count);
|
||||
int i2c_master_recv(struct i2c_client *client, char *buf, int count);
|
||||
|
||||
These routines read and write some bytes from/to a client. The client
|
||||
contains the i2c address, so you do not have to include it. The second
|
||||
parameter contains the bytes the read/write, the third the length of the
|
||||
buffer. Returned is the actual number of bytes read/written.
|
||||
|
||||
extern int i2c_transfer(struct i2c_adapter *adap, struct i2c_msg *msg,
|
||||
int num);
|
||||
parameter contains the bytes to read/write, the third the number of bytes
|
||||
to read/write (must be less than the length of the buffer.) Returned is
|
||||
the actual number of bytes read/written.
|
||||
|
||||
int i2c_transfer(struct i2c_adapter *adap, struct i2c_msg *msg,
|
||||
int num);
|
||||
|
||||
This sends a series of messages. Each message can be a read or write,
|
||||
and they can be mixed in any way. The transactions are combined: no
|
||||
|
@ -583,49 +330,45 @@ for each message the client address, the number of bytes of the message
|
|||
and the message data itself.
|
||||
|
||||
You can read the file `i2c-protocol' for more information about the
|
||||
actual i2c protocol.
|
||||
actual I2C protocol.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
SMBus communication
|
||||
-------------------
|
||||
|
||||
extern s32 i2c_smbus_xfer (struct i2c_adapter * adapter, u16 addr,
|
||||
unsigned short flags,
|
||||
char read_write, u8 command, int size,
|
||||
union i2c_smbus_data * data);
|
||||
s32 i2c_smbus_xfer(struct i2c_adapter *adapter, u16 addr,
|
||||
unsigned short flags, char read_write, u8 command,
|
||||
int size, union i2c_smbus_data *data);
|
||||
|
||||
This is the generic SMBus function. All functions below are implemented
|
||||
in terms of it. Never use this function directly!
|
||||
This is the generic SMBus function. All functions below are implemented
|
||||
in terms of it. Never use this function directly!
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
extern s32 i2c_smbus_read_byte(struct i2c_client * client);
|
||||
extern s32 i2c_smbus_write_byte(struct i2c_client * client, u8 value);
|
||||
extern s32 i2c_smbus_read_byte_data(struct i2c_client * client, u8 command);
|
||||
extern s32 i2c_smbus_write_byte_data(struct i2c_client * client,
|
||||
u8 command, u8 value);
|
||||
extern s32 i2c_smbus_read_word_data(struct i2c_client * client, u8 command);
|
||||
extern s32 i2c_smbus_write_word_data(struct i2c_client * client,
|
||||
u8 command, u16 value);
|
||||
extern s32 i2c_smbus_process_call(struct i2c_client *client,
|
||||
u8 command, u16 value);
|
||||
extern s32 i2c_smbus_read_block_data(struct i2c_client * client,
|
||||
u8 command, u8 *values);
|
||||
extern s32 i2c_smbus_write_block_data(struct i2c_client * client,
|
||||
u8 command, u8 length,
|
||||
u8 *values);
|
||||
extern s32 i2c_smbus_read_i2c_block_data(struct i2c_client * client,
|
||||
u8 command, u8 length, u8 *values);
|
||||
extern s32 i2c_smbus_write_i2c_block_data(struct i2c_client * client,
|
||||
u8 command, u8 length,
|
||||
u8 *values);
|
||||
s32 i2c_smbus_read_byte(struct i2c_client *client);
|
||||
s32 i2c_smbus_write_byte(struct i2c_client *client, u8 value);
|
||||
s32 i2c_smbus_read_byte_data(struct i2c_client *client, u8 command);
|
||||
s32 i2c_smbus_write_byte_data(struct i2c_client *client,
|
||||
u8 command, u8 value);
|
||||
s32 i2c_smbus_read_word_data(struct i2c_client *client, u8 command);
|
||||
s32 i2c_smbus_write_word_data(struct i2c_client *client,
|
||||
u8 command, u16 value);
|
||||
s32 i2c_smbus_process_call(struct i2c_client *client,
|
||||
u8 command, u16 value);
|
||||
s32 i2c_smbus_read_block_data(struct i2c_client *client,
|
||||
u8 command, u8 *values);
|
||||
s32 i2c_smbus_write_block_data(struct i2c_client *client,
|
||||
u8 command, u8 length, const u8 *values);
|
||||
s32 i2c_smbus_read_i2c_block_data(struct i2c_client *client,
|
||||
u8 command, u8 length, u8 *values);
|
||||
s32 i2c_smbus_write_i2c_block_data(struct i2c_client *client,
|
||||
u8 command, u8 length,
|
||||
const u8 *values);
|
||||
|
||||
These ones were removed from i2c-core because they had no users, but could
|
||||
be added back later if needed:
|
||||
|
||||
extern s32 i2c_smbus_write_quick(struct i2c_client * client, u8 value);
|
||||
extern s32 i2c_smbus_block_process_call(struct i2c_client *client,
|
||||
u8 command, u8 length,
|
||||
u8 *values)
|
||||
s32 i2c_smbus_write_quick(struct i2c_client *client, u8 value);
|
||||
s32 i2c_smbus_block_process_call(struct i2c_client *client,
|
||||
u8 command, u8 length, u8 *values);
|
||||
|
||||
All these transactions return a negative errno value on failure. The 'write'
|
||||
transactions return 0 on success; the 'read' transactions return the read
|
||||
|
@ -642,7 +385,5 @@ General purpose routines
|
|||
Below all general purpose routines are listed, that were not mentioned
|
||||
before.
|
||||
|
||||
/* This call returns a unique low identifier for each registered adapter.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
extern int i2c_adapter_id(struct i2c_adapter *adap);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Return the adapter number for a specific adapter */
|
||||
int i2c_adapter_id(struct i2c_adapter *adap);
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,183 @@
|
|||
Recipe for getting/building/running Xen/ia64 with pv_ops
|
||||
--------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
This recipe describes how to get xen-ia64 source and build it,
|
||||
and run domU with pv_ops.
|
||||
|
||||
============
|
||||
Requirements
|
||||
============
|
||||
|
||||
- python
|
||||
- mercurial
|
||||
it (aka "hg") is an open-source source code
|
||||
management software. See the below.
|
||||
http://www.selenic.com/mercurial/wiki/
|
||||
- git
|
||||
- bridge-utils
|
||||
|
||||
=================================
|
||||
Getting and Building Xen and Dom0
|
||||
=================================
|
||||
|
||||
My environment is;
|
||||
Machine : Tiger4
|
||||
Domain0 OS : RHEL5
|
||||
DomainU OS : RHEL5
|
||||
|
||||
1. Download source
|
||||
# hg clone http://xenbits.xensource.com/ext/ia64/xen-unstable.hg
|
||||
# cd xen-unstable.hg
|
||||
# hg clone http://xenbits.xensource.com/ext/ia64/linux-2.6.18-xen.hg
|
||||
|
||||
2. # make world
|
||||
|
||||
3. # make install-tools
|
||||
|
||||
4. copy kernels and xen
|
||||
# cp xen/xen.gz /boot/efi/efi/redhat/
|
||||
# cp build-linux-2.6.18-xen_ia64/vmlinux.gz \
|
||||
/boot/efi/efi/redhat/vmlinuz-2.6.18.8-xen
|
||||
|
||||
5. make initrd for Dom0/DomU
|
||||
# make -C linux-2.6.18-xen.hg ARCH=ia64 modules_install \
|
||||
O=$(/bin/pwd)/build-linux-2.6.18-xen_ia64
|
||||
# mkinitrd -f /boot/efi/efi/redhat/initrd-2.6.18.8-xen.img \
|
||||
2.6.18.8-xen --builtin mptspi --builtin mptbase \
|
||||
--builtin mptscsih --builtin uhci-hcd --builtin ohci-hcd \
|
||||
--builtin ehci-hcd
|
||||
|
||||
================================
|
||||
Making a disk image for guest OS
|
||||
================================
|
||||
|
||||
1. make file
|
||||
# dd if=/dev/zero of=/root/rhel5.img bs=1M seek=4096 count=0
|
||||
# mke2fs -F -j /root/rhel5.img
|
||||
# mount -o loop /root/rhel5.img /mnt
|
||||
# cp -ax /{dev,var,etc,usr,bin,sbin,lib} /mnt
|
||||
# mkdir /mnt/{root,proc,sys,home,tmp}
|
||||
|
||||
Note: You may miss some device files. If so, please create them
|
||||
with mknod. Or you can use tar instead of cp.
|
||||
|
||||
2. modify DomU's fstab
|
||||
# vi /mnt/etc/fstab
|
||||
/dev/xvda1 / ext3 defaults 1 1
|
||||
none /dev/pts devpts gid=5,mode=620 0 0
|
||||
none /dev/shm tmpfs defaults 0 0
|
||||
none /proc proc defaults 0 0
|
||||
none /sys sysfs defaults 0 0
|
||||
|
||||
3. modify inittab
|
||||
set runlevel to 3 to avoid X trying to start
|
||||
# vi /mnt/etc/inittab
|
||||
id:3:initdefault:
|
||||
Start a getty on the hvc0 console
|
||||
X0:2345:respawn:/sbin/mingetty hvc0
|
||||
tty1-6 mingetty can be commented out
|
||||
|
||||
4. add hvc0 into /etc/securetty
|
||||
# vi /mnt/etc/securetty (add hvc0)
|
||||
|
||||
5. umount
|
||||
# umount /mnt
|
||||
|
||||
FYI, virt-manager can also make a disk image for guest OS.
|
||||
It's GUI tools and easy to make it.
|
||||
|
||||
==================
|
||||
Boot Xen & Domain0
|
||||
==================
|
||||
|
||||
1. replace elilo
|
||||
elilo of RHEL5 can boot Xen and Dom0.
|
||||
If you use old elilo (e.g RHEL4), please download from the below
|
||||
http://elilo.sourceforge.net/cgi-bin/blosxom
|
||||
and copy into /boot/efi/efi/redhat/
|
||||
# cp elilo-3.6-ia64.efi /boot/efi/efi/redhat/elilo.efi
|
||||
|
||||
2. modify elilo.conf (like the below)
|
||||
# vi /boot/efi/efi/redhat/elilo.conf
|
||||
prompt
|
||||
timeout=20
|
||||
default=xen
|
||||
relocatable
|
||||
|
||||
image=vmlinuz-2.6.18.8-xen
|
||||
label=xen
|
||||
vmm=xen.gz
|
||||
initrd=initrd-2.6.18.8-xen.img
|
||||
read-only
|
||||
append=" -- rhgb root=/dev/sda2"
|
||||
|
||||
The append options before "--" are for xen hypervisor,
|
||||
the options after "--" are for dom0.
|
||||
|
||||
FYI, your machine may need console options like
|
||||
"com1=19200,8n1 console=vga,com1". For example,
|
||||
append="com1=19200,8n1 console=vga,com1 -- rhgb console=tty0 \
|
||||
console=ttyS0 root=/dev/sda2"
|
||||
|
||||
=====================================
|
||||
Getting and Building domU with pv_ops
|
||||
=====================================
|
||||
|
||||
1. get pv_ops tree
|
||||
# git clone http://people.valinux.co.jp/~yamahata/xen-ia64/linux-2.6-xen-ia64.git/
|
||||
|
||||
2. git branch (if necessary)
|
||||
# cd linux-2.6-xen-ia64/
|
||||
# git checkout -b your_branch origin/xen-ia64-domu-minimal-2008may19
|
||||
(Note: The current branch is xen-ia64-domu-minimal-2008may19.
|
||||
But you would find the new branch. You can see with
|
||||
"git branch -r" to get the branch lists.
|
||||
http://people.valinux.co.jp/~yamahata/xen-ia64/for_eagl/linux-2.6-ia64-pv-ops.git/
|
||||
is also available. The tree is based on
|
||||
git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/aegl/linux-2.6 test)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
3. copy .config for pv_ops of domU
|
||||
# cp arch/ia64/configs/xen_domu_wip_defconfig .config
|
||||
|
||||
4. make kernel with pv_ops
|
||||
# make oldconfig
|
||||
# make
|
||||
|
||||
5. install the kernel and initrd
|
||||
# cp vmlinux.gz /boot/efi/efi/redhat/vmlinuz-2.6-pv_ops-xenU
|
||||
# make modules_install
|
||||
# mkinitrd -f /boot/efi/efi/redhat/initrd-2.6-pv_ops-xenU.img \
|
||||
2.6.26-rc3xen-ia64-08941-g1b12161 --builtin mptspi \
|
||||
--builtin mptbase --builtin mptscsih --builtin uhci-hcd \
|
||||
--builtin ohci-hcd --builtin ehci-hcd
|
||||
|
||||
========================
|
||||
Boot DomainU with pv_ops
|
||||
========================
|
||||
|
||||
1. make config of DomU
|
||||
# vi /etc/xen/rhel5
|
||||
kernel = "/boot/efi/efi/redhat/vmlinuz-2.6-pv_ops-xenU"
|
||||
ramdisk = "/boot/efi/efi/redhat/initrd-2.6-pv_ops-xenU.img"
|
||||
vcpus = 1
|
||||
memory = 512
|
||||
name = "rhel5"
|
||||
disk = [ 'file:/root/rhel5.img,xvda1,w' ]
|
||||
root = "/dev/xvda1 ro"
|
||||
extra= "rhgb console=hvc0"
|
||||
|
||||
2. After boot xen and dom0, start xend
|
||||
# /etc/init.d/xend start
|
||||
( In the debugging case, # XEND_DEBUG=1 xend trace_start )
|
||||
|
||||
3. start domU
|
||||
# xm create -c rhel5
|
||||
|
||||
=========
|
||||
Reference
|
||||
=========
|
||||
- Wiki of Xen/IA64 upstream merge
|
||||
http://wiki.xensource.com/xenwiki/XenIA64/UpstreamMerge
|
||||
|
||||
Written by Akio Takebe <takebe_akio@jp.fujitsu.com> on 28 May 2008
|
|
@ -92,6 +92,7 @@ Code Seq# Include File Comments
|
|||
'J' 00-1F drivers/scsi/gdth_ioctl.h
|
||||
'K' all linux/kd.h
|
||||
'L' 00-1F linux/loop.h
|
||||
'L' 20-2F driver/usb/misc/vstusb.h
|
||||
'L' E0-FF linux/ppdd.h encrypted disk device driver
|
||||
<http://linux01.gwdg.de/~alatham/ppdd.html>
|
||||
'M' all linux/soundcard.h
|
||||
|
@ -110,6 +111,8 @@ Code Seq# Include File Comments
|
|||
'W' 00-1F linux/wanrouter.h conflict!
|
||||
'X' all linux/xfs_fs.h
|
||||
'Y' all linux/cyclades.h
|
||||
'[' 00-07 linux/usb/usbtmc.h USB Test and Measurement Devices
|
||||
<mailto:gregkh@suse.de>
|
||||
'a' all ATM on linux
|
||||
<http://lrcwww.epfl.ch/linux-atm/magic.html>
|
||||
'b' 00-FF bit3 vme host bridge
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -109,7 +109,8 @@ There are two possible methods of using Kdump.
|
|||
2) Or use the system kernel binary itself as dump-capture kernel and there is
|
||||
no need to build a separate dump-capture kernel. This is possible
|
||||
only with the architecutres which support a relocatable kernel. As
|
||||
of today, i386, x86_64 and ia64 architectures support relocatable kernel.
|
||||
of today, i386, x86_64, ppc64 and ia64 architectures support relocatable
|
||||
kernel.
|
||||
|
||||
Building a relocatable kernel is advantageous from the point of view that
|
||||
one does not have to build a second kernel for capturing the dump. But
|
||||
|
@ -207,8 +208,15 @@ Dump-capture kernel config options (Arch Dependent, i386 and x86_64)
|
|||
Dump-capture kernel config options (Arch Dependent, ppc64)
|
||||
----------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
* Make and install the kernel and its modules. DO NOT add this kernel
|
||||
to the boot loader configuration files.
|
||||
1) Enable "Build a kdump crash kernel" support under "Kernel" options:
|
||||
|
||||
CONFIG_CRASH_DUMP=y
|
||||
|
||||
2) Enable "Build a relocatable kernel" support
|
||||
|
||||
CONFIG_RELOCATABLE=y
|
||||
|
||||
Make and install the kernel and its modules.
|
||||
|
||||
Dump-capture kernel config options (Arch Dependent, ia64)
|
||||
----------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -101,6 +101,7 @@ parameter is applicable:
|
|||
X86-64 X86-64 architecture is enabled.
|
||||
More X86-64 boot options can be found in
|
||||
Documentation/x86_64/boot-options.txt .
|
||||
X86 Either 32bit or 64bit x86 (same as X86-32+X86-64)
|
||||
|
||||
In addition, the following text indicates that the option:
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -217,20 +218,47 @@ and is between 256 and 4096 characters. It is defined in the file
|
|||
acpi.debug_level= [HW,ACPI]
|
||||
Format: <int>
|
||||
Each bit of the <int> indicates an ACPI debug level,
|
||||
1: enable, 0: disable. It is useful for boot time
|
||||
debugging. After system has booted up, it can be set
|
||||
via /sys/module/acpi/parameters/debug_level.
|
||||
CONFIG_ACPI_DEBUG must be enabled for this to produce any output.
|
||||
Available bits (add the numbers together) to enable different
|
||||
debug output levels of the ACPI subsystem:
|
||||
0x01 error 0x02 warn 0x04 init 0x08 debug object
|
||||
0x10 info 0x20 init names 0x40 parse 0x80 load
|
||||
0x100 dispatch 0x200 execute 0x400 names 0x800 operation region
|
||||
0x1000 bfield 0x2000 tables 0x4000 values 0x8000 objects
|
||||
0x10000 resources 0x20000 user requests 0x40000 package.
|
||||
The number can be in decimal or prefixed with 0x in hex.
|
||||
Warning: Many of these options can produce a lot of
|
||||
output and make your system unusable. Be very careful.
|
||||
which corresponds to the level in an ACPI_DEBUG_PRINT
|
||||
statement. After system has booted up, this mask
|
||||
can be set via /sys/module/acpi/parameters/debug_level.
|
||||
|
||||
CONFIG_ACPI_DEBUG must be enabled for this to produce
|
||||
any output. The number can be in decimal or prefixed
|
||||
with 0x in hex. Some of these options produce so much
|
||||
output that the system is unusable.
|
||||
|
||||
The following global components are defined by the
|
||||
ACPI CA:
|
||||
0x01 error
|
||||
0x02 warn
|
||||
0x04 init
|
||||
0x08 debug object
|
||||
0x10 info
|
||||
0x20 init names
|
||||
0x40 parse
|
||||
0x80 load
|
||||
0x100 dispatch
|
||||
0x200 execute
|
||||
0x400 names
|
||||
0x800 operation region
|
||||
0x1000 bfield
|
||||
0x2000 tables
|
||||
0x4000 values
|
||||
0x8000 objects
|
||||
0x10000 resources
|
||||
0x20000 user requests
|
||||
0x40000 package
|
||||
The number can be in decimal or prefixed with 0x in hex.
|
||||
Warning: Many of these options can produce a lot of
|
||||
output and make your system unusable. Be very careful.
|
||||
|
||||
acpi.power_nocheck= [HW,ACPI]
|
||||
Format: 1/0 enable/disable the check of power state.
|
||||
On some bogus BIOS the _PSC object/_STA object of
|
||||
power resource can't return the correct device power
|
||||
state. In such case it is unneccessary to check its
|
||||
power state again in power transition.
|
||||
1 : disable the power state check
|
||||
|
||||
acpi_pm_good [X86-32,X86-64]
|
||||
Override the pmtimer bug detection: force the kernel
|
||||
|
@ -690,7 +718,7 @@ and is between 256 and 4096 characters. It is defined in the file
|
|||
See Documentation/block/as-iosched.txt and
|
||||
Documentation/block/deadline-iosched.txt for details.
|
||||
|
||||
elfcorehdr= [X86-32, X86_64]
|
||||
elfcorehdr= [IA64,PPC,SH,X86-32,X86_64]
|
||||
Specifies physical address of start of kernel core
|
||||
image elf header. Generally kexec loader will
|
||||
pass this option to capture kernel.
|
||||
|
@ -796,6 +824,8 @@ and is between 256 and 4096 characters. It is defined in the file
|
|||
Defaults to the default architecture's huge page size
|
||||
if not specified.
|
||||
|
||||
hlt [BUGS=ARM,SH]
|
||||
|
||||
i8042.debug [HW] Toggle i8042 debug mode
|
||||
i8042.direct [HW] Put keyboard port into non-translated mode
|
||||
i8042.dumbkbd [HW] Pretend that controller can only read data from
|
||||
|
@ -1211,6 +1241,10 @@ and is between 256 and 4096 characters. It is defined in the file
|
|||
mem=nopentium [BUGS=X86-32] Disable usage of 4MB pages for kernel
|
||||
memory.
|
||||
|
||||
memchunk=nn[KMG]
|
||||
[KNL,SH] Allow user to override the default size for
|
||||
per-device physically contiguous DMA buffers.
|
||||
|
||||
memmap=exactmap [KNL,X86-32,X86_64] Enable setting of an exact
|
||||
E820 memory map, as specified by the user.
|
||||
Such memmap=exactmap lines can be constructed based on
|
||||
|
@ -1393,6 +1427,8 @@ and is between 256 and 4096 characters. It is defined in the file
|
|||
|
||||
nodisconnect [HW,SCSI,M68K] Disables SCSI disconnects.
|
||||
|
||||
nodsp [SH] Disable hardware DSP at boot time.
|
||||
|
||||
noefi [X86-32,X86-64] Disable EFI runtime services support.
|
||||
|
||||
noexec [IA-64]
|
||||
|
@ -1409,13 +1445,15 @@ and is between 256 and 4096 characters. It is defined in the file
|
|||
noexec32=off: disable non-executable mappings
|
||||
read implies executable mappings
|
||||
|
||||
nofpu [SH] Disable hardware FPU at boot time.
|
||||
|
||||
nofxsr [BUGS=X86-32] Disables x86 floating point extended
|
||||
register save and restore. The kernel will only save
|
||||
legacy floating-point registers on task switch.
|
||||
|
||||
noclflush [BUGS=X86] Don't use the CLFLUSH instruction
|
||||
|
||||
nohlt [BUGS=ARM]
|
||||
nohlt [BUGS=ARM,SH]
|
||||
|
||||
no-hlt [BUGS=X86-32] Tells the kernel that the hlt
|
||||
instruction doesn't work correctly and not to
|
||||
|
@ -1578,7 +1616,7 @@ and is between 256 and 4096 characters. It is defined in the file
|
|||
See also Documentation/paride.txt.
|
||||
|
||||
pci=option[,option...] [PCI] various PCI subsystem options:
|
||||
off [X86-32] don't probe for the PCI bus
|
||||
off [X86] don't probe for the PCI bus
|
||||
bios [X86-32] force use of PCI BIOS, don't access
|
||||
the hardware directly. Use this if your machine
|
||||
has a non-standard PCI host bridge.
|
||||
|
@ -1586,9 +1624,9 @@ and is between 256 and 4096 characters. It is defined in the file
|
|||
hardware access methods are allowed. Use this
|
||||
if you experience crashes upon bootup and you
|
||||
suspect they are caused by the BIOS.
|
||||
conf1 [X86-32] Force use of PCI Configuration
|
||||
conf1 [X86] Force use of PCI Configuration
|
||||
Mechanism 1.
|
||||
conf2 [X86-32] Force use of PCI Configuration
|
||||
conf2 [X86] Force use of PCI Configuration
|
||||
Mechanism 2.
|
||||
noaer [PCIE] If the PCIEAER kernel config parameter is
|
||||
enabled, this kernel boot option can be used to
|
||||
|
@ -1608,37 +1646,37 @@ and is between 256 and 4096 characters. It is defined in the file
|
|||
this option if the kernel is unable to allocate
|
||||
IRQs or discover secondary PCI buses on your
|
||||
motherboard.
|
||||
rom [X86-32] Assign address space to expansion ROMs.
|
||||
rom [X86] Assign address space to expansion ROMs.
|
||||
Use with caution as certain devices share
|
||||
address decoders between ROMs and other
|
||||
resources.
|
||||
norom [X86-32,X86_64] Do not assign address space to
|
||||
norom [X86] Do not assign address space to
|
||||
expansion ROMs that do not already have
|
||||
BIOS assigned address ranges.
|
||||
irqmask=0xMMMM [X86-32] Set a bit mask of IRQs allowed to be
|
||||
irqmask=0xMMMM [X86] Set a bit mask of IRQs allowed to be
|
||||
assigned automatically to PCI devices. You can
|
||||
make the kernel exclude IRQs of your ISA cards
|
||||
this way.
|
||||
pirqaddr=0xAAAAA [X86-32] Specify the physical address
|
||||
pirqaddr=0xAAAAA [X86] Specify the physical address
|
||||
of the PIRQ table (normally generated
|
||||
by the BIOS) if it is outside the
|
||||
F0000h-100000h range.
|
||||
lastbus=N [X86-32] Scan all buses thru bus #N. Can be
|
||||
lastbus=N [X86] Scan all buses thru bus #N. Can be
|
||||
useful if the kernel is unable to find your
|
||||
secondary buses and you want to tell it
|
||||
explicitly which ones they are.
|
||||
assign-busses [X86-32] Always assign all PCI bus
|
||||
assign-busses [X86] Always assign all PCI bus
|
||||
numbers ourselves, overriding
|
||||
whatever the firmware may have done.
|
||||
usepirqmask [X86-32] Honor the possible IRQ mask stored
|
||||
usepirqmask [X86] Honor the possible IRQ mask stored
|
||||
in the BIOS $PIR table. This is needed on
|
||||
some systems with broken BIOSes, notably
|
||||
some HP Pavilion N5400 and Omnibook XE3
|
||||
notebooks. This will have no effect if ACPI
|
||||
IRQ routing is enabled.
|
||||
noacpi [X86-32] Do not use ACPI for IRQ routing
|
||||
noacpi [X86] Do not use ACPI for IRQ routing
|
||||
or for PCI scanning.
|
||||
use_crs [X86-32] Use _CRS for PCI resource
|
||||
use_crs [X86] Use _CRS for PCI resource
|
||||
allocation.
|
||||
routeirq Do IRQ routing for all PCI devices.
|
||||
This is normally done in pci_enable_device(),
|
||||
|
@ -1667,6 +1705,12 @@ and is between 256 and 4096 characters. It is defined in the file
|
|||
reserved for the CardBus bridge's memory
|
||||
window. The default value is 64 megabytes.
|
||||
|
||||
pcie_aspm= [PCIE] Forcibly enable or disable PCIe Active State Power
|
||||
Management.
|
||||
off Disable ASPM.
|
||||
force Enable ASPM even on devices that claim not to support it.
|
||||
WARNING: Forcing ASPM on may cause system lockups.
|
||||
|
||||
pcmv= [HW,PCMCIA] BadgePAD 4
|
||||
|
||||
pd. [PARIDE]
|
||||
|
@ -1694,6 +1738,10 @@ and is between 256 and 4096 characters. It is defined in the file
|
|||
Override pmtimer IOPort with a hex value.
|
||||
e.g. pmtmr=0x508
|
||||
|
||||
pnp.debug [PNP]
|
||||
Enable PNP debug messages. This depends on the
|
||||
CONFIG_PNP_DEBUG_MESSAGES option.
|
||||
|
||||
pnpacpi= [ACPI]
|
||||
{ off }
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -2191,7 +2239,7 @@ and is between 256 and 4096 characters. It is defined in the file
|
|||
|
||||
thermal.crt= [HW,ACPI]
|
||||
-1: disable all critical trip points in all thermal zones
|
||||
<degrees C>: lower all critical trip points
|
||||
<degrees C>: override all critical trip points
|
||||
|
||||
thermal.nocrt= [HW,ACPI]
|
||||
Set to disable actions on ACPI thermal zone
|
||||
|
@ -2253,6 +2301,25 @@ and is between 256 and 4096 characters. It is defined in the file
|
|||
autosuspended. Devices for which the delay is set
|
||||
to a negative value won't be autosuspended at all.
|
||||
|
||||
usbcore.usbfs_snoop=
|
||||
[USB] Set to log all usbfs traffic (default 0 = off).
|
||||
|
||||
usbcore.blinkenlights=
|
||||
[USB] Set to cycle leds on hubs (default 0 = off).
|
||||
|
||||
usbcore.old_scheme_first=
|
||||
[USB] Start with the old device initialization
|
||||
scheme (default 0 = off).
|
||||
|
||||
usbcore.use_both_schemes=
|
||||
[USB] Try the other device initialization scheme
|
||||
if the first one fails (default 1 = enabled).
|
||||
|
||||
usbcore.initial_descriptor_timeout=
|
||||
[USB] Specifies timeout for the initial 64-byte
|
||||
USB_REQ_GET_DESCRIPTOR request in milliseconds
|
||||
(default 5000 = 5.0 seconds).
|
||||
|
||||
usbhid.mousepoll=
|
||||
[USBHID] The interval which mice are to be polled at.
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
|
|||
Acer Laptop WMI Extras Driver
|
||||
http://code.google.com/p/aceracpi
|
||||
Version 0.1
|
||||
9th February 2008
|
||||
Version 0.2
|
||||
18th August 2008
|
||||
|
||||
Copyright 2007-2008 Carlos Corbacho <carlos@strangeworlds.co.uk>
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -87,17 +87,7 @@ acer-wmi come with built-in wireless. However, should you feel so inclined to
|
|||
ever wish to remove the card, or swap it out at some point, please get in touch
|
||||
with me, as we may well be able to gain some data on wireless card detection.
|
||||
|
||||
To read the status of the wireless radio (0=off, 1=on):
|
||||
cat /sys/devices/platform/acer-wmi/wireless
|
||||
|
||||
To enable the wireless radio:
|
||||
echo 1 > /sys/devices/platform/acer-wmi/wireless
|
||||
|
||||
To disable the wireless radio:
|
||||
echo 0 > /sys/devices/platform/acer-wmi/wireless
|
||||
|
||||
To set the state of the wireless radio when loading acer-wmi, pass:
|
||||
wireless=X (where X is 0 or 1)
|
||||
The wireless radio is exposed through rfkill.
|
||||
|
||||
Bluetooth
|
||||
*********
|
||||
|
@ -117,17 +107,7 @@ For the adventurously minded - if you want to buy an internal bluetooth
|
|||
module off the internet that is compatible with your laptop and fit it, then
|
||||
it will work just fine with acer-wmi.
|
||||
|
||||
To read the status of the bluetooth module (0=off, 1=on):
|
||||
cat /sys/devices/platform/acer-wmi/wireless
|
||||
|
||||
To enable the bluetooth module:
|
||||
echo 1 > /sys/devices/platform/acer-wmi/bluetooth
|
||||
|
||||
To disable the bluetooth module:
|
||||
echo 0 > /sys/devices/platform/acer-wmi/bluetooth
|
||||
|
||||
To set the state of the bluetooth module when loading acer-wmi, pass:
|
||||
bluetooth=X (where X is 0 or 1)
|
||||
Bluetooth is exposed through rfkill.
|
||||
|
||||
3G
|
||||
**
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -50,10 +50,12 @@ Connecting a function (probe) to a marker is done by providing a probe (function
|
|||
to call) for the specific marker through marker_probe_register() and can be
|
||||
activated by calling marker_arm(). Marker deactivation can be done by calling
|
||||
marker_disarm() as many times as marker_arm() has been called. Removing a probe
|
||||
is done through marker_probe_unregister(); it will disarm the probe and make
|
||||
sure there is no caller left using the probe when it returns. Probe removal is
|
||||
preempt-safe because preemption is disabled around the probe call. See the
|
||||
"Probe example" section below for a sample probe module.
|
||||
is done through marker_probe_unregister(); it will disarm the probe.
|
||||
marker_synchronize_unregister() must be called before the end of the module exit
|
||||
function to make sure there is no caller left using the probe. This, and the
|
||||
fact that preemption is disabled around the probe call, make sure that probe
|
||||
removal and module unload are safe. See the "Probe example" section below for a
|
||||
sample probe module.
|
||||
|
||||
The marker mechanism supports inserting multiple instances of the same marker.
|
||||
Markers can be put in inline functions, inlined static functions, and
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,714 @@
|
|||
Introduction
|
||||
============
|
||||
|
||||
Having looked at the linux mtd/nand driver and more specific at nand_ecc.c
|
||||
I felt there was room for optimisation. I bashed the code for a few hours
|
||||
performing tricks like table lookup removing superfluous code etc.
|
||||
After that the speed was increased by 35-40%.
|
||||
Still I was not too happy as I felt there was additional room for improvement.
|
||||
|
||||
Bad! I was hooked.
|
||||
I decided to annotate my steps in this file. Perhaps it is useful to someone
|
||||
or someone learns something from it.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
The problem
|
||||
===========
|
||||
|
||||
NAND flash (at least SLC one) typically has sectors of 256 bytes.
|
||||
However NAND flash is not extremely reliable so some error detection
|
||||
(and sometimes correction) is needed.
|
||||
|
||||
This is done by means of a Hamming code. I'll try to explain it in
|
||||
laymans terms (and apologies to all the pro's in the field in case I do
|
||||
not use the right terminology, my coding theory class was almost 30
|
||||
years ago, and I must admit it was not one of my favourites).
|
||||
|
||||
As I said before the ecc calculation is performed on sectors of 256
|
||||
bytes. This is done by calculating several parity bits over the rows and
|
||||
columns. The parity used is even parity which means that the parity bit = 1
|
||||
if the data over which the parity is calculated is 1 and the parity bit = 0
|
||||
if the data over which the parity is calculated is 0. So the total
|
||||
number of bits over the data over which the parity is calculated + the
|
||||
parity bit is even. (see wikipedia if you can't follow this).
|
||||
Parity is often calculated by means of an exclusive or operation,
|
||||
sometimes also referred to as xor. In C the operator for xor is ^
|
||||
|
||||
Back to ecc.
|
||||
Let's give a small figure:
|
||||
|
||||
byte 0: bit7 bit6 bit5 bit4 bit3 bit2 bit1 bit0 rp0 rp2 rp4 ... rp14
|
||||
byte 1: bit7 bit6 bit5 bit4 bit3 bit2 bit1 bit0 rp1 rp2 rp4 ... rp14
|
||||
byte 2: bit7 bit6 bit5 bit4 bit3 bit2 bit1 bit0 rp0 rp3 rp4 ... rp14
|
||||
byte 3: bit7 bit6 bit5 bit4 bit3 bit2 bit1 bit0 rp1 rp3 rp4 ... rp14
|
||||
byte 4: bit7 bit6 bit5 bit4 bit3 bit2 bit1 bit0 rp0 rp2 rp5 ... rp14
|
||||
....
|
||||
byte 254: bit7 bit6 bit5 bit4 bit3 bit2 bit1 bit0 rp0 rp3 rp5 ... rp15
|
||||
byte 255: bit7 bit6 bit5 bit4 bit3 bit2 bit1 bit0 rp1 rp3 rp5 ... rp15
|
||||
cp1 cp0 cp1 cp0 cp1 cp0 cp1 cp0
|
||||
cp3 cp3 cp2 cp2 cp3 cp3 cp2 cp2
|
||||
cp5 cp5 cp5 cp5 cp4 cp4 cp4 cp4
|
||||
|
||||
This figure represents a sector of 256 bytes.
|
||||
cp is my abbreviaton for column parity, rp for row parity.
|
||||
|
||||
Let's start to explain column parity.
|
||||
cp0 is the parity that belongs to all bit0, bit2, bit4, bit6.
|
||||
so the sum of all bit0, bit2, bit4 and bit6 values + cp0 itself is even.
|
||||
Similarly cp1 is the sum of all bit1, bit3, bit5 and bit7.
|
||||
cp2 is the parity over bit0, bit1, bit4 and bit5
|
||||
cp3 is the parity over bit2, bit3, bit6 and bit7.
|
||||
cp4 is the parity over bit0, bit1, bit2 and bit3.
|
||||
cp5 is the parity over bit4, bit5, bit6 and bit7.
|
||||
Note that each of cp0 .. cp5 is exactly one bit.
|
||||
|
||||
Row parity actually works almost the same.
|
||||
rp0 is the parity of all even bytes (0, 2, 4, 6, ... 252, 254)
|
||||
rp1 is the parity of all odd bytes (1, 3, 5, 7, ..., 253, 255)
|
||||
rp2 is the parity of all bytes 0, 1, 4, 5, 8, 9, ...
|
||||
(so handle two bytes, then skip 2 bytes).
|
||||
rp3 is covers the half rp2 does not cover (bytes 2, 3, 6, 7, 10, 11, ...)
|
||||
for rp4 the rule is cover 4 bytes, skip 4 bytes, cover 4 bytes, skip 4 etc.
|
||||
so rp4 calculates parity over bytes 0, 1, 2, 3, 8, 9, 10, 11, 16, ...)
|
||||
and rp5 covers the other half, so bytes 4, 5, 6, 7, 12, 13, 14, 15, 20, ..
|
||||
The story now becomes quite boring. I guess you get the idea.
|
||||
rp6 covers 8 bytes then skips 8 etc
|
||||
rp7 skips 8 bytes then covers 8 etc
|
||||
rp8 covers 16 bytes then skips 16 etc
|
||||
rp9 skips 16 bytes then covers 16 etc
|
||||
rp10 covers 32 bytes then skips 32 etc
|
||||
rp11 skips 32 bytes then covers 32 etc
|
||||
rp12 covers 64 bytes then skips 64 etc
|
||||
rp13 skips 64 bytes then covers 64 etc
|
||||
rp14 covers 128 bytes then skips 128
|
||||
rp15 skips 128 bytes then covers 128
|
||||
|
||||
In the end the parity bits are grouped together in three bytes as
|
||||
follows:
|
||||
ECC Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
|
||||
ECC 0 rp07 rp06 rp05 rp04 rp03 rp02 rp01 rp00
|
||||
ECC 1 rp15 rp14 rp13 rp12 rp11 rp10 rp09 rp08
|
||||
ECC 2 cp5 cp4 cp3 cp2 cp1 cp0 1 1
|
||||
|
||||
I detected after writing this that ST application note AN1823
|
||||
(http://www.st.com/stonline/books/pdf/docs/10123.pdf) gives a much
|
||||
nicer picture.(but they use line parity as term where I use row parity)
|
||||
Oh well, I'm graphically challenged, so suffer with me for a moment :-)
|
||||
And I could not reuse the ST picture anyway for copyright reasons.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Attempt 0
|
||||
=========
|
||||
|
||||
Implementing the parity calculation is pretty simple.
|
||||
In C pseudocode:
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < 256; i++)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (i & 0x01)
|
||||
rp1 = bit7 ^ bit6 ^ bit5 ^ bit4 ^ bit3 ^ bit2 ^ bit1 ^ bit0 ^ rp1;
|
||||
else
|
||||
rp0 = bit7 ^ bit6 ^ bit5 ^ bit4 ^ bit3 ^ bit2 ^ bit1 ^ bit0 ^ rp1;
|
||||
if (i & 0x02)
|
||||
rp3 = bit7 ^ bit6 ^ bit5 ^ bit4 ^ bit3 ^ bit2 ^ bit1 ^ bit0 ^ rp3;
|
||||
else
|
||||
rp2 = bit7 ^ bit6 ^ bit5 ^ bit4 ^ bit3 ^ bit2 ^ bit1 ^ bit0 ^ rp2;
|
||||
if (i & 0x04)
|
||||
rp5 = bit7 ^ bit6 ^ bit5 ^ bit4 ^ bit3 ^ bit2 ^ bit1 ^ bit0 ^ rp5;
|
||||
else
|
||||
rp4 = bit7 ^ bit6 ^ bit5 ^ bit4 ^ bit3 ^ bit2 ^ bit1 ^ bit0 ^ rp4;
|
||||
if (i & 0x08)
|
||||
rp7 = bit7 ^ bit6 ^ bit5 ^ bit4 ^ bit3 ^ bit2 ^ bit1 ^ bit0 ^ rp7;
|
||||
else
|
||||
rp6 = bit7 ^ bit6 ^ bit5 ^ bit4 ^ bit3 ^ bit2 ^ bit1 ^ bit0 ^ rp6;
|
||||
if (i & 0x10)
|
||||
rp9 = bit7 ^ bit6 ^ bit5 ^ bit4 ^ bit3 ^ bit2 ^ bit1 ^ bit0 ^ rp9;
|
||||
else
|
||||
rp8 = bit7 ^ bit6 ^ bit5 ^ bit4 ^ bit3 ^ bit2 ^ bit1 ^ bit0 ^ rp8;
|
||||
if (i & 0x20)
|
||||
rp11 = bit7 ^ bit6 ^ bit5 ^ bit4 ^ bit3 ^ bit2 ^ bit1 ^ bit0 ^ rp11;
|
||||
else
|
||||
rp10 = bit7 ^ bit6 ^ bit5 ^ bit4 ^ bit3 ^ bit2 ^ bit1 ^ bit0 ^ rp10;
|
||||
if (i & 0x40)
|
||||
rp13 = bit7 ^ bit6 ^ bit5 ^ bit4 ^ bit3 ^ bit2 ^ bit1 ^ bit0 ^ rp13;
|
||||
else
|
||||
rp12 = bit7 ^ bit6 ^ bit5 ^ bit4 ^ bit3 ^ bit2 ^ bit1 ^ bit0 ^ rp12;
|
||||
if (i & 0x80)
|
||||
rp15 = bit7 ^ bit6 ^ bit5 ^ bit4 ^ bit3 ^ bit2 ^ bit1 ^ bit0 ^ rp15;
|
||||
else
|
||||
rp14 = bit7 ^ bit6 ^ bit5 ^ bit4 ^ bit3 ^ bit2 ^ bit1 ^ bit0 ^ rp14;
|
||||
cp0 = bit6 ^ bit4 ^ bit2 ^ bit0 ^ cp0;
|
||||
cp1 = bit7 ^ bit5 ^ bit3 ^ bit1 ^ cp1;
|
||||
cp2 = bit5 ^ bit4 ^ bit1 ^ bit0 ^ cp2;
|
||||
cp3 = bit7 ^ bit6 ^ bit3 ^ bit2 ^ cp3
|
||||
cp4 = bit3 ^ bit2 ^ bit1 ^ bit0 ^ cp4
|
||||
cp5 = bit7 ^ bit6 ^ bit5 ^ bit4 ^ cp5
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Analysis 0
|
||||
==========
|
||||
|
||||
C does have bitwise operators but not really operators to do the above
|
||||
efficiently (and most hardware has no such instructions either).
|
||||
Therefore without implementing this it was clear that the code above was
|
||||
not going to bring me a Nobel prize :-)
|
||||
|
||||
Fortunately the exclusive or operation is commutative, so we can combine
|
||||
the values in any order. So instead of calculating all the bits
|
||||
individually, let us try to rearrange things.
|
||||
For the column parity this is easy. We can just xor the bytes and in the
|
||||
end filter out the relevant bits. This is pretty nice as it will bring
|
||||
all cp calculation out of the if loop.
|
||||
|
||||
Similarly we can first xor the bytes for the various rows.
|
||||
This leads to:
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Attempt 1
|
||||
=========
|
||||
|
||||
const char parity[256] = {
|
||||
0, 1, 1, 0, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 0,
|
||||
1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 1, 0, 0, 1,
|
||||
1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 1, 0, 0, 1,
|
||||
0, 1, 1, 0, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 0,
|
||||
1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 1, 0, 0, 1,
|
||||
0, 1, 1, 0, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 0,
|
||||
0, 1, 1, 0, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 0,
|
||||
1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 1, 0, 0, 1,
|
||||
1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 1, 0, 0, 1,
|
||||
0, 1, 1, 0, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 0,
|
||||
0, 1, 1, 0, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 0,
|
||||
1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 1, 0, 0, 1,
|
||||
0, 1, 1, 0, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 0,
|
||||
1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 1, 0, 0, 1,
|
||||
1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 1, 0, 0, 1,
|
||||
0, 1, 1, 0, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 0, 1, 1, 0
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
void ecc1(const unsigned char *buf, unsigned char *code)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int i;
|
||||
const unsigned char *bp = buf;
|
||||
unsigned char cur;
|
||||
unsigned char rp0, rp1, rp2, rp3, rp4, rp5, rp6, rp7;
|
||||
unsigned char rp8, rp9, rp10, rp11, rp12, rp13, rp14, rp15;
|
||||
unsigned char par;
|
||||
|
||||
par = 0;
|
||||
rp0 = 0; rp1 = 0; rp2 = 0; rp3 = 0;
|
||||
rp4 = 0; rp5 = 0; rp6 = 0; rp7 = 0;
|
||||
rp8 = 0; rp9 = 0; rp10 = 0; rp11 = 0;
|
||||
rp12 = 0; rp13 = 0; rp14 = 0; rp15 = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < 256; i++)
|
||||
{
|
||||
cur = *bp++;
|
||||
par ^= cur;
|
||||
if (i & 0x01) rp1 ^= cur; else rp0 ^= cur;
|
||||
if (i & 0x02) rp3 ^= cur; else rp2 ^= cur;
|
||||
if (i & 0x04) rp5 ^= cur; else rp4 ^= cur;
|
||||
if (i & 0x08) rp7 ^= cur; else rp6 ^= cur;
|
||||
if (i & 0x10) rp9 ^= cur; else rp8 ^= cur;
|
||||
if (i & 0x20) rp11 ^= cur; else rp10 ^= cur;
|
||||
if (i & 0x40) rp13 ^= cur; else rp12 ^= cur;
|
||||
if (i & 0x80) rp15 ^= cur; else rp14 ^= cur;
|
||||
}
|
||||
code[0] =
|
||||
(parity[rp7] << 7) |
|
||||
(parity[rp6] << 6) |
|
||||
(parity[rp5] << 5) |
|
||||
(parity[rp4] << 4) |
|
||||
(parity[rp3] << 3) |
|
||||
(parity[rp2] << 2) |
|
||||
(parity[rp1] << 1) |
|
||||
(parity[rp0]);
|
||||
code[1] =
|
||||
(parity[rp15] << 7) |
|
||||
(parity[rp14] << 6) |
|
||||
(parity[rp13] << 5) |
|
||||
(parity[rp12] << 4) |
|
||||
(parity[rp11] << 3) |
|
||||
(parity[rp10] << 2) |
|
||||
(parity[rp9] << 1) |
|
||||
(parity[rp8]);
|
||||
code[2] =
|
||||
(parity[par & 0xf0] << 7) |
|
||||
(parity[par & 0x0f] << 6) |
|
||||
(parity[par & 0xcc] << 5) |
|
||||
(parity[par & 0x33] << 4) |
|
||||
(parity[par & 0xaa] << 3) |
|
||||
(parity[par & 0x55] << 2);
|
||||
code[0] = ~code[0];
|
||||
code[1] = ~code[1];
|
||||
code[2] = ~code[2];
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
Still pretty straightforward. The last three invert statements are there to
|
||||
give a checksum of 0xff 0xff 0xff for an empty flash. In an empty flash
|
||||
all data is 0xff, so the checksum then matches.
|
||||
|
||||
I also introduced the parity lookup. I expected this to be the fastest
|
||||
way to calculate the parity, but I will investigate alternatives later
|
||||
on.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Analysis 1
|
||||
==========
|
||||
|
||||
The code works, but is not terribly efficient. On my system it took
|
||||
almost 4 times as much time as the linux driver code. But hey, if it was
|
||||
*that* easy this would have been done long before.
|
||||
No pain. no gain.
|
||||
|
||||
Fortunately there is plenty of room for improvement.
|
||||
|
||||
In step 1 we moved from bit-wise calculation to byte-wise calculation.
|
||||
However in C we can also use the unsigned long data type and virtually
|
||||
every modern microprocessor supports 32 bit operations, so why not try
|
||||
to write our code in such a way that we process data in 32 bit chunks.
|
||||
|
||||
Of course this means some modification as the row parity is byte by
|
||||
byte. A quick analysis:
|
||||
for the column parity we use the par variable. When extending to 32 bits
|
||||
we can in the end easily calculate p0 and p1 from it.
|
||||
(because par now consists of 4 bytes, contributing to rp1, rp0, rp1, rp0
|
||||
respectively)
|
||||
also rp2 and rp3 can be easily retrieved from par as rp3 covers the
|
||||
first two bytes and rp2 the last two bytes.
|
||||
|
||||
Note that of course now the loop is executed only 64 times (256/4).
|
||||
And note that care must taken wrt byte ordering. The way bytes are
|
||||
ordered in a long is machine dependent, and might affect us.
|
||||
Anyway, if there is an issue: this code is developed on x86 (to be
|
||||
precise: a DELL PC with a D920 Intel CPU)
|
||||
|
||||
And of course the performance might depend on alignment, but I expect
|
||||
that the I/O buffers in the nand driver are aligned properly (and
|
||||
otherwise that should be fixed to get maximum performance).
|
||||
|
||||
Let's give it a try...
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Attempt 2
|
||||
=========
|
||||
|
||||
extern const char parity[256];
|
||||
|
||||
void ecc2(const unsigned char *buf, unsigned char *code)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int i;
|
||||
const unsigned long *bp = (unsigned long *)buf;
|
||||
unsigned long cur;
|
||||
unsigned long rp0, rp1, rp2, rp3, rp4, rp5, rp6, rp7;
|
||||
unsigned long rp8, rp9, rp10, rp11, rp12, rp13, rp14, rp15;
|
||||
unsigned long par;
|
||||
|
||||
par = 0;
|
||||
rp0 = 0; rp1 = 0; rp2 = 0; rp3 = 0;
|
||||
rp4 = 0; rp5 = 0; rp6 = 0; rp7 = 0;
|
||||
rp8 = 0; rp9 = 0; rp10 = 0; rp11 = 0;
|
||||
rp12 = 0; rp13 = 0; rp14 = 0; rp15 = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < 64; i++)
|
||||
{
|
||||
cur = *bp++;
|
||||
par ^= cur;
|
||||
if (i & 0x01) rp5 ^= cur; else rp4 ^= cur;
|
||||
if (i & 0x02) rp7 ^= cur; else rp6 ^= cur;
|
||||
if (i & 0x04) rp9 ^= cur; else rp8 ^= cur;
|
||||
if (i & 0x08) rp11 ^= cur; else rp10 ^= cur;
|
||||
if (i & 0x10) rp13 ^= cur; else rp12 ^= cur;
|
||||
if (i & 0x20) rp15 ^= cur; else rp14 ^= cur;
|
||||
}
|
||||
/*
|
||||
we need to adapt the code generation for the fact that rp vars are now
|
||||
long; also the column parity calculation needs to be changed.
|
||||
we'll bring rp4 to 15 back to single byte entities by shifting and
|
||||
xoring
|
||||
*/
|
||||
rp4 ^= (rp4 >> 16); rp4 ^= (rp4 >> 8); rp4 &= 0xff;
|
||||
rp5 ^= (rp5 >> 16); rp5 ^= (rp5 >> 8); rp5 &= 0xff;
|
||||
rp6 ^= (rp6 >> 16); rp6 ^= (rp6 >> 8); rp6 &= 0xff;
|
||||
rp7 ^= (rp7 >> 16); rp7 ^= (rp7 >> 8); rp7 &= 0xff;
|
||||
rp8 ^= (rp8 >> 16); rp8 ^= (rp8 >> 8); rp8 &= 0xff;
|
||||
rp9 ^= (rp9 >> 16); rp9 ^= (rp9 >> 8); rp9 &= 0xff;
|
||||
rp10 ^= (rp10 >> 16); rp10 ^= (rp10 >> 8); rp10 &= 0xff;
|
||||
rp11 ^= (rp11 >> 16); rp11 ^= (rp11 >> 8); rp11 &= 0xff;
|
||||
rp12 ^= (rp12 >> 16); rp12 ^= (rp12 >> 8); rp12 &= 0xff;
|
||||
rp13 ^= (rp13 >> 16); rp13 ^= (rp13 >> 8); rp13 &= 0xff;
|
||||
rp14 ^= (rp14 >> 16); rp14 ^= (rp14 >> 8); rp14 &= 0xff;
|
||||
rp15 ^= (rp15 >> 16); rp15 ^= (rp15 >> 8); rp15 &= 0xff;
|
||||
rp3 = (par >> 16); rp3 ^= (rp3 >> 8); rp3 &= 0xff;
|
||||
rp2 = par & 0xffff; rp2 ^= (rp2 >> 8); rp2 &= 0xff;
|
||||
par ^= (par >> 16);
|
||||
rp1 = (par >> 8); rp1 &= 0xff;
|
||||
rp0 = (par & 0xff);
|
||||
par ^= (par >> 8); par &= 0xff;
|
||||
|
||||
code[0] =
|
||||
(parity[rp7] << 7) |
|
||||
(parity[rp6] << 6) |
|
||||
(parity[rp5] << 5) |
|
||||
(parity[rp4] << 4) |
|
||||
(parity[rp3] << 3) |
|
||||
(parity[rp2] << 2) |
|
||||
(parity[rp1] << 1) |
|
||||
(parity[rp0]);
|
||||
code[1] =
|
||||
(parity[rp15] << 7) |
|
||||
(parity[rp14] << 6) |
|
||||
(parity[rp13] << 5) |
|
||||
(parity[rp12] << 4) |
|
||||
(parity[rp11] << 3) |
|
||||
(parity[rp10] << 2) |
|
||||
(parity[rp9] << 1) |
|
||||
(parity[rp8]);
|
||||
code[2] =
|
||||
(parity[par & 0xf0] << 7) |
|
||||
(parity[par & 0x0f] << 6) |
|
||||
(parity[par & 0xcc] << 5) |
|
||||
(parity[par & 0x33] << 4) |
|
||||
(parity[par & 0xaa] << 3) |
|
||||
(parity[par & 0x55] << 2);
|
||||
code[0] = ~code[0];
|
||||
code[1] = ~code[1];
|
||||
code[2] = ~code[2];
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
The parity array is not shown any more. Note also that for these
|
||||
examples I kinda deviated from my regular programming style by allowing
|
||||
multiple statements on a line, not using { } in then and else blocks
|
||||
with only a single statement and by using operators like ^=
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Analysis 2
|
||||
==========
|
||||
|
||||
The code (of course) works, and hurray: we are a little bit faster than
|
||||
the linux driver code (about 15%). But wait, don't cheer too quickly.
|
||||
THere is more to be gained.
|
||||
If we look at e.g. rp14 and rp15 we see that we either xor our data with
|
||||
rp14 or with rp15. However we also have par which goes over all data.
|
||||
This means there is no need to calculate rp14 as it can be calculated from
|
||||
rp15 through rp14 = par ^ rp15;
|
||||
(or if desired we can avoid calculating rp15 and calculate it from
|
||||
rp14). That is why some places refer to inverse parity.
|
||||
Of course the same thing holds for rp4/5, rp6/7, rp8/9, rp10/11 and rp12/13.
|
||||
Effectively this means we can eliminate the else clause from the if
|
||||
statements. Also we can optimise the calculation in the end a little bit
|
||||
by going from long to byte first. Actually we can even avoid the table
|
||||
lookups
|
||||
|
||||
Attempt 3
|
||||
=========
|
||||
|
||||
Odd replaced:
|
||||
if (i & 0x01) rp5 ^= cur; else rp4 ^= cur;
|
||||
if (i & 0x02) rp7 ^= cur; else rp6 ^= cur;
|
||||
if (i & 0x04) rp9 ^= cur; else rp8 ^= cur;
|
||||
if (i & 0x08) rp11 ^= cur; else rp10 ^= cur;
|
||||
if (i & 0x10) rp13 ^= cur; else rp12 ^= cur;
|
||||
if (i & 0x20) rp15 ^= cur; else rp14 ^= cur;
|
||||
with
|
||||
if (i & 0x01) rp5 ^= cur;
|
||||
if (i & 0x02) rp7 ^= cur;
|
||||
if (i & 0x04) rp9 ^= cur;
|
||||
if (i & 0x08) rp11 ^= cur;
|
||||
if (i & 0x10) rp13 ^= cur;
|
||||
if (i & 0x20) rp15 ^= cur;
|
||||
|
||||
and outside the loop added:
|
||||
rp4 = par ^ rp5;
|
||||
rp6 = par ^ rp7;
|
||||
rp8 = par ^ rp9;
|
||||
rp10 = par ^ rp11;
|
||||
rp12 = par ^ rp13;
|
||||
rp14 = par ^ rp15;
|
||||
|
||||
And after that the code takes about 30% more time, although the number of
|
||||
statements is reduced. This is also reflected in the assembly code.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Analysis 3
|
||||
==========
|
||||
|
||||
Very weird. Guess it has to do with caching or instruction parallellism
|
||||
or so. I also tried on an eeePC (Celeron, clocked at 900 Mhz). Interesting
|
||||
observation was that this one is only 30% slower (according to time)
|
||||
executing the code as my 3Ghz D920 processor.
|
||||
|
||||
Well, it was expected not to be easy so maybe instead move to a
|
||||
different track: let's move back to the code from attempt2 and do some
|
||||
loop unrolling. This will eliminate a few if statements. I'll try
|
||||
different amounts of unrolling to see what works best.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Attempt 4
|
||||
=========
|
||||
|
||||
Unrolled the loop 1, 2, 3 and 4 times.
|
||||
For 4 the code starts with:
|
||||
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
|
||||
{
|
||||
cur = *bp++;
|
||||
par ^= cur;
|
||||
rp4 ^= cur;
|
||||
rp6 ^= cur;
|
||||
rp8 ^= cur;
|
||||
rp10 ^= cur;
|
||||
if (i & 0x1) rp13 ^= cur; else rp12 ^= cur;
|
||||
if (i & 0x2) rp15 ^= cur; else rp14 ^= cur;
|
||||
cur = *bp++;
|
||||
par ^= cur;
|
||||
rp5 ^= cur;
|
||||
rp6 ^= cur;
|
||||
...
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Analysis 4
|
||||
==========
|
||||
|
||||
Unrolling once gains about 15%
|
||||
Unrolling twice keeps the gain at about 15%
|
||||
Unrolling three times gives a gain of 30% compared to attempt 2.
|
||||
Unrolling four times gives a marginal improvement compared to unrolling
|
||||
three times.
|
||||
|
||||
I decided to proceed with a four time unrolled loop anyway. It was my gut
|
||||
feeling that in the next steps I would obtain additional gain from it.
|
||||
|
||||
The next step was triggered by the fact that par contains the xor of all
|
||||
bytes and rp4 and rp5 each contain the xor of half of the bytes.
|
||||
So in effect par = rp4 ^ rp5. But as xor is commutative we can also say
|
||||
that rp5 = par ^ rp4. So no need to keep both rp4 and rp5 around. We can
|
||||
eliminate rp5 (or rp4, but I already foresaw another optimisation).
|
||||
The same holds for rp6/7, rp8/9, rp10/11 rp12/13 and rp14/15.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Attempt 5
|
||||
=========
|
||||
|
||||
Effectively so all odd digit rp assignments in the loop were removed.
|
||||
This included the else clause of the if statements.
|
||||
Of course after the loop we need to correct things by adding code like:
|
||||
rp5 = par ^ rp4;
|
||||
Also the initial assignments (rp5 = 0; etc) could be removed.
|
||||
Along the line I also removed the initialisation of rp0/1/2/3.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Analysis 5
|
||||
==========
|
||||
|
||||
Measurements showed this was a good move. The run-time roughly halved
|
||||
compared with attempt 4 with 4 times unrolled, and we only require 1/3rd
|
||||
of the processor time compared to the current code in the linux kernel.
|
||||
|
||||
However, still I thought there was more. I didn't like all the if
|
||||
statements. Why not keep a running parity and only keep the last if
|
||||
statement. Time for yet another version!
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Attempt 6
|
||||
=========
|
||||
|
||||
THe code within the for loop was changed to:
|
||||
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
|
||||
{
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar = cur; rp4 ^= cur;
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp6 ^= tmppar;
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp4 ^= cur;
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp8 ^= tmppar;
|
||||
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp4 ^= cur; rp6 ^= cur;
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp6 ^= cur;
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp4 ^= cur;
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp10 ^= tmppar;
|
||||
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp4 ^= cur; rp6 ^= cur; rp8 ^= cur;
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp6 ^= cur; rp8 ^= cur;
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp4 ^= cur; rp8 ^= cur;
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp8 ^= cur;
|
||||
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp4 ^= cur; rp6 ^= cur;
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp6 ^= cur;
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp4 ^= cur;
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur;
|
||||
|
||||
par ^= tmppar;
|
||||
if ((i & 0x1) == 0) rp12 ^= tmppar;
|
||||
if ((i & 0x2) == 0) rp14 ^= tmppar;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
As you can see tmppar is used to accumulate the parity within a for
|
||||
iteration. In the last 3 statements is is added to par and, if needed,
|
||||
to rp12 and rp14.
|
||||
|
||||
While making the changes I also found that I could exploit that tmppar
|
||||
contains the running parity for this iteration. So instead of having:
|
||||
rp4 ^= cur; rp6 = cur;
|
||||
I removed the rp6 = cur; statement and did rp6 ^= tmppar; on next
|
||||
statement. A similar change was done for rp8 and rp10
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Analysis 6
|
||||
==========
|
||||
|
||||
Measuring this code again showed big gain. When executing the original
|
||||
linux code 1 million times, this took about 1 second on my system.
|
||||
(using time to measure the performance). After this iteration I was back
|
||||
to 0.075 sec. Actually I had to decide to start measuring over 10
|
||||
million interations in order not to loose too much accuracy. This one
|
||||
definitely seemed to be the jackpot!
|
||||
|
||||
There is a little bit more room for improvement though. There are three
|
||||
places with statements:
|
||||
rp4 ^= cur; rp6 ^= cur;
|
||||
It seems more efficient to also maintain a variable rp4_6 in the while
|
||||
loop; This eliminates 3 statements per loop. Of course after the loop we
|
||||
need to correct by adding:
|
||||
rp4 ^= rp4_6;
|
||||
rp6 ^= rp4_6
|
||||
Furthermore there are 4 sequential assingments to rp8. This can be
|
||||
encoded slightly more efficient by saving tmppar before those 4 lines
|
||||
and later do rp8 = rp8 ^ tmppar ^ notrp8;
|
||||
(where notrp8 is the value of rp8 before those 4 lines).
|
||||
Again a use of the commutative property of xor.
|
||||
Time for a new test!
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Attempt 7
|
||||
=========
|
||||
|
||||
The new code now looks like:
|
||||
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
|
||||
{
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar = cur; rp4 ^= cur;
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp6 ^= tmppar;
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp4 ^= cur;
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp8 ^= tmppar;
|
||||
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp4_6 ^= cur;
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp6 ^= cur;
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp4 ^= cur;
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp10 ^= tmppar;
|
||||
|
||||
notrp8 = tmppar;
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp4_6 ^= cur;
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp6 ^= cur;
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp4 ^= cur;
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur;
|
||||
rp8 = rp8 ^ tmppar ^ notrp8;
|
||||
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp4_6 ^= cur;
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp6 ^= cur;
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur; rp4 ^= cur;
|
||||
cur = *bp++; tmppar ^= cur;
|
||||
|
||||
par ^= tmppar;
|
||||
if ((i & 0x1) == 0) rp12 ^= tmppar;
|
||||
if ((i & 0x2) == 0) rp14 ^= tmppar;
|
||||
}
|
||||
rp4 ^= rp4_6;
|
||||
rp6 ^= rp4_6;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Not a big change, but every penny counts :-)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Analysis 7
|
||||
==========
|
||||
|
||||
Acutally this made things worse. Not very much, but I don't want to move
|
||||
into the wrong direction. Maybe something to investigate later. Could
|
||||
have to do with caching again.
|
||||
|
||||
Guess that is what there is to win within the loop. Maybe unrolling one
|
||||
more time will help. I'll keep the optimisations from 7 for now.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Attempt 8
|
||||
=========
|
||||
|
||||
Unrolled the loop one more time.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Analysis 8
|
||||
==========
|
||||
|
||||
This makes things worse. Let's stick with attempt 6 and continue from there.
|
||||
Although it seems that the code within the loop cannot be optimised
|
||||
further there is still room to optimize the generation of the ecc codes.
|
||||
We can simply calcualate the total parity. If this is 0 then rp4 = rp5
|
||||
etc. If the parity is 1, then rp4 = !rp5;
|
||||
But if rp4 = rp5 we do not need rp5 etc. We can just write the even bits
|
||||
in the result byte and then do something like
|
||||
code[0] |= (code[0] << 1);
|
||||
Lets test this.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Attempt 9
|
||||
=========
|
||||
|
||||
Changed the code but again this slightly degrades performance. Tried all
|
||||
kind of other things, like having dedicated parity arrays to avoid the
|
||||
shift after parity[rp7] << 7; No gain.
|
||||
Change the lookup using the parity array by using shift operators (e.g.
|
||||
replace parity[rp7] << 7 with:
|
||||
rp7 ^= (rp7 << 4);
|
||||
rp7 ^= (rp7 << 2);
|
||||
rp7 ^= (rp7 << 1);
|
||||
rp7 &= 0x80;
|
||||
No gain.
|
||||
|
||||
The only marginal change was inverting the parity bits, so we can remove
|
||||
the last three invert statements.
|
||||
|
||||
Ah well, pity this does not deliver more. Then again 10 million
|
||||
iterations using the linux driver code takes between 13 and 13.5
|
||||
seconds, whereas my code now takes about 0.73 seconds for those 10
|
||||
million iterations. So basically I've improved the performance by a
|
||||
factor 18 on my system. Not that bad. Of course on different hardware
|
||||
you will get different results. No warranties!
|
||||
|
||||
But of course there is no such thing as a free lunch. The codesize almost
|
||||
tripled (from 562 bytes to 1434 bytes). Then again, it is not that much.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Correcting errors
|
||||
=================
|
||||
|
||||
For correcting errors I again used the ST application note as a starter,
|
||||
but I also peeked at the existing code.
|
||||
The algorithm itself is pretty straightforward. Just xor the given and
|
||||
the calculated ecc. If all bytes are 0 there is no problem. If 11 bits
|
||||
are 1 we have one correctable bit error. If there is 1 bit 1, we have an
|
||||
error in the given ecc code.
|
||||
It proved to be fastest to do some table lookups. Performance gain
|
||||
introduced by this is about a factor 2 on my system when a repair had to
|
||||
be done, and 1% or so if no repair had to be done.
|
||||
Code size increased from 330 bytes to 686 bytes for this function.
|
||||
(gcc 4.2, -O3)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Conclusion
|
||||
==========
|
||||
|
||||
The gain when calculating the ecc is tremendous. Om my development hardware
|
||||
a speedup of a factor of 18 for ecc calculation was achieved. On a test on an
|
||||
embedded system with a MIPS core a factor 7 was obtained.
|
||||
On a test with a Linksys NSLU2 (ARMv5TE processor) the speedup was a factor
|
||||
5 (big endian mode, gcc 4.1.2, -O3)
|
||||
For correction not much gain could be obtained (as bitflips are rare). Then
|
||||
again there are also much less cycles spent there.
|
||||
|
||||
It seems there is not much more gain possible in this, at least when
|
||||
programmed in C. Of course it might be possible to squeeze something more
|
||||
out of it with an assembler program, but due to pipeline behaviour etc
|
||||
this is very tricky (at least for intel hw).
|
||||
|
||||
Author: Frans Meulenbroeks
|
||||
Copyright (C) 2008 Koninklijke Philips Electronics NV.
|
|
@ -1917,6 +1917,8 @@ platforms are moved over to use the flattened-device-tree model.
|
|||
inverse clock polarity (CPOL) mode
|
||||
- spi-cpha - (optional) Empty property indicating device requires
|
||||
shifted clock phase (CPHA) mode
|
||||
- spi-cs-high - (optional) Empty property indicating device requires
|
||||
chip select active high
|
||||
|
||||
SPI example for an MPC5200 SPI bus:
|
||||
spi@f00 {
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -2,13 +2,13 @@
|
|||
|
||||
Required properties:
|
||||
|
||||
- device_type : Should be "board-control"
|
||||
- compatible : Should be "fsl,<board>-bcsr"
|
||||
- reg : Offset and length of the register set for the device
|
||||
|
||||
Example:
|
||||
|
||||
bcsr@f8000000 {
|
||||
device_type = "board-control";
|
||||
compatible = "fsl,mpc8360mds-bcsr";
|
||||
reg = <f8000000 8000>;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -369,4 +369,5 @@ can be ORed together:
|
|||
2 - A module was force loaded by insmod -f.
|
||||
Set by modutils >= 2.4.9 and module-init-tools.
|
||||
4 - Unsafe SMP processors: SMP with CPUs not designed for SMP.
|
||||
64 - A module from drivers/staging was loaded.
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -95,7 +95,9 @@ On all - write a character to /proc/sysrq-trigger. e.g.:
|
|||
|
||||
'p' - Will dump the current registers and flags to your console.
|
||||
|
||||
'q' - Will dump a list of all running timers.
|
||||
'q' - Will dump per CPU lists of all armed hrtimers (but NOT regular
|
||||
timer_list timers) and detailed information about all
|
||||
clockevent devices.
|
||||
|
||||
'r' - Turns off keyboard raw mode and sets it to XLATE.
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,101 @@
|
|||
Using the Linux Kernel Tracepoints
|
||||
|
||||
Mathieu Desnoyers
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
This document introduces Linux Kernel Tracepoints and their use. It provides
|
||||
examples of how to insert tracepoints in the kernel and connect probe functions
|
||||
to them and provides some examples of probe functions.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
* Purpose of tracepoints
|
||||
|
||||
A tracepoint placed in code provides a hook to call a function (probe) that you
|
||||
can provide at runtime. A tracepoint can be "on" (a probe is connected to it) or
|
||||
"off" (no probe is attached). When a tracepoint is "off" it has no effect,
|
||||
except for adding a tiny time penalty (checking a condition for a branch) and
|
||||
space penalty (adding a few bytes for the function call at the end of the
|
||||
instrumented function and adds a data structure in a separate section). When a
|
||||
tracepoint is "on", the function you provide is called each time the tracepoint
|
||||
is executed, in the execution context of the caller. When the function provided
|
||||
ends its execution, it returns to the caller (continuing from the tracepoint
|
||||
site).
|
||||
|
||||
You can put tracepoints at important locations in the code. They are
|
||||
lightweight hooks that can pass an arbitrary number of parameters,
|
||||
which prototypes are described in a tracepoint declaration placed in a header
|
||||
file.
|
||||
|
||||
They can be used for tracing and performance accounting.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
* Usage
|
||||
|
||||
Two elements are required for tracepoints :
|
||||
|
||||
- A tracepoint definition, placed in a header file.
|
||||
- The tracepoint statement, in C code.
|
||||
|
||||
In order to use tracepoints, you should include linux/tracepoint.h.
|
||||
|
||||
In include/trace/subsys.h :
|
||||
|
||||
#include <linux/tracepoint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
DEFINE_TRACE(subsys_eventname,
|
||||
TPPTOTO(int firstarg, struct task_struct *p),
|
||||
TPARGS(firstarg, p));
|
||||
|
||||
In subsys/file.c (where the tracing statement must be added) :
|
||||
|
||||
#include <trace/subsys.h>
|
||||
|
||||
void somefct(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
...
|
||||
trace_subsys_eventname(arg, task);
|
||||
...
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
Where :
|
||||
- subsys_eventname is an identifier unique to your event
|
||||
- subsys is the name of your subsystem.
|
||||
- eventname is the name of the event to trace.
|
||||
- TPPTOTO(int firstarg, struct task_struct *p) is the prototype of the function
|
||||
called by this tracepoint.
|
||||
- TPARGS(firstarg, p) are the parameters names, same as found in the prototype.
|
||||
|
||||
Connecting a function (probe) to a tracepoint is done by providing a probe
|
||||
(function to call) for the specific tracepoint through
|
||||
register_trace_subsys_eventname(). Removing a probe is done through
|
||||
unregister_trace_subsys_eventname(); it will remove the probe sure there is no
|
||||
caller left using the probe when it returns. Probe removal is preempt-safe
|
||||
because preemption is disabled around the probe call. See the "Probe example"
|
||||
section below for a sample probe module.
|
||||
|
||||
The tracepoint mechanism supports inserting multiple instances of the same
|
||||
tracepoint, but a single definition must be made of a given tracepoint name over
|
||||
all the kernel to make sure no type conflict will occur. Name mangling of the
|
||||
tracepoints is done using the prototypes to make sure typing is correct.
|
||||
Verification of probe type correctness is done at the registration site by the
|
||||
compiler. Tracepoints can be put in inline functions, inlined static functions,
|
||||
and unrolled loops as well as regular functions.
|
||||
|
||||
The naming scheme "subsys_event" is suggested here as a convention intended
|
||||
to limit collisions. Tracepoint names are global to the kernel: they are
|
||||
considered as being the same whether they are in the core kernel image or in
|
||||
modules.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
* Probe / tracepoint example
|
||||
|
||||
See the example provided in samples/tracepoints/src
|
||||
|
||||
Compile them with your kernel.
|
||||
|
||||
Run, as root :
|
||||
modprobe tracepoint-example (insmod order is not important)
|
||||
modprobe tracepoint-probe-example
|
||||
cat /proc/tracepoint-example (returns an expected error)
|
||||
rmmod tracepoint-example tracepoint-probe-example
|
||||
dmesg
|
|
@ -36,7 +36,7 @@ $ mount -t debugfs debugfs /debug
|
|||
$ echo mmiotrace > /debug/tracing/current_tracer
|
||||
$ cat /debug/tracing/trace_pipe > mydump.txt &
|
||||
Start X or whatever.
|
||||
$ echo "X is up" > /debug/tracing/marker
|
||||
$ echo "X is up" > /debug/tracing/trace_marker
|
||||
$ echo none > /debug/tracing/current_tracer
|
||||
Check for lost events.
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -59,9 +59,8 @@ The 'cat' process should stay running (sleeping) in the background.
|
|||
Load the driver you want to trace and use it. Mmiotrace will only catch MMIO
|
||||
accesses to areas that are ioremapped while mmiotrace is active.
|
||||
|
||||
[Unimplemented feature:]
|
||||
During tracing you can place comments (markers) into the trace by
|
||||
$ echo "X is up" > /debug/tracing/marker
|
||||
$ echo "X is up" > /debug/tracing/trace_marker
|
||||
This makes it easier to see which part of the (huge) trace corresponds to
|
||||
which action. It is recommended to place descriptive markers about what you
|
||||
do.
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,448 @@
|
|||
|
||||
Linux UWB + Wireless USB + WiNET
|
||||
|
||||
(C) 2005-2006 Intel Corporation
|
||||
Inaky Perez-Gonzalez <inaky.perez-gonzalez@intel.com>
|
||||
|
||||
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
|
||||
modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License version
|
||||
2 as published by the Free Software Foundation.
|
||||
|
||||
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
|
||||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||||
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
|
||||
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
|
||||
02110-1301, USA.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Please visit http://bughost.org/thewiki/Design-overview.txt-1.8 for
|
||||
updated content.
|
||||
|
||||
* Design-overview.txt-1.8
|
||||
|
||||
This code implements a Ultra Wide Band stack for Linux, as well as
|
||||
drivers for the the USB based UWB radio controllers defined in the
|
||||
Wireless USB 1.0 specification (including Wireless USB host controller
|
||||
and an Intel WiNET controller).
|
||||
|
||||
1. Introduction
|
||||
1. HWA: Host Wire adapters, your Wireless USB dongle
|
||||
|
||||
2. DWA: Device Wired Adaptor, a Wireless USB hub for wired
|
||||
devices
|
||||
3. WHCI: Wireless Host Controller Interface, the PCI WUSB host
|
||||
adapter
|
||||
2. The UWB stack
|
||||
1. Devices and hosts: the basic structure
|
||||
|
||||
2. Host Controller life cycle
|
||||
|
||||
3. On the air: beacons and enumerating the radio neighborhood
|
||||
|
||||
4. Device lists
|
||||
5. Bandwidth allocation
|
||||
|
||||
3. Wireless USB Host Controller drivers
|
||||
|
||||
4. Glossary
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Introduction
|
||||
|
||||
UWB is a wide-band communication protocol that is to serve also as the
|
||||
low-level protocol for others (much like TCP sits on IP). Currently
|
||||
these others are Wireless USB and TCP/IP, but seems Bluetooth and
|
||||
Firewire/1394 are coming along.
|
||||
|
||||
UWB uses a band from roughly 3 to 10 GHz, transmitting at a max of
|
||||
~-41dB (or 0.074 uW/MHz--geography specific data is still being
|
||||
negotiated w/ regulators, so watch for changes). That band is divided in
|
||||
a bunch of ~1.5 GHz wide channels (or band groups) composed of three
|
||||
subbands/subchannels (528 MHz each). Each channel is independent of each
|
||||
other, so you could consider them different "busses". Initially this
|
||||
driver considers them all a single one.
|
||||
|
||||
Radio time is divided in 65536 us long /superframes/, each one divided
|
||||
in 256 256us long /MASs/ (Media Allocation Slots), which are the basic
|
||||
time/media allocation units for transferring data. At the beginning of
|
||||
each superframe there is a Beacon Period (BP), where every device
|
||||
transmit its beacon on a single MAS. The length of the BP depends on how
|
||||
many devices are present and the length of their beacons.
|
||||
|
||||
Devices have a MAC (fixed, 48 bit address) and a device (changeable, 16
|
||||
bit address) and send periodic beacons to advertise themselves and pass
|
||||
info on what they are and do. They advertise their capabilities and a
|
||||
bunch of other stuff.
|
||||
|
||||
The different logical parts of this driver are:
|
||||
|
||||
*
|
||||
|
||||
*UWB*: the Ultra-Wide-Band stack -- manages the radio and
|
||||
associated spectrum to allow for devices sharing it. Allows to
|
||||
control bandwidth assingment, beaconing, scanning, etc
|
||||
|
||||
*
|
||||
|
||||
*WUSB*: the layer that sits on top of UWB to provide Wireless USB.
|
||||
The Wireless USB spec defines means to control a UWB radio and to
|
||||
do the actual WUSB.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
HWA: Host Wire adapters, your Wireless USB dongle
|
||||
|
||||
WUSB also defines a device called a Host Wire Adaptor (HWA), which in
|
||||
mere terms is a USB dongle that enables your PC to have UWB and Wireless
|
||||
USB. The Wireless USB Host Controller in a HWA looks to the host like a
|
||||
[Wireless] USB controller connected via USB (!)
|
||||
|
||||
The HWA itself is broken in two or three main interfaces:
|
||||
|
||||
*
|
||||
|
||||
*RC*: Radio control -- this implements an interface to the
|
||||
Ultra-Wide-Band radio controller. The driver for this implements a
|
||||
USB-based UWB Radio Controller to the UWB stack.
|
||||
|
||||
*
|
||||
|
||||
*HC*: the wireless USB host controller. It looks like a USB host
|
||||
whose root port is the radio and the WUSB devices connect to it.
|
||||
To the system it looks like a separate USB host. The driver (will)
|
||||
implement a USB host controller (similar to UHCI, OHCI or EHCI)
|
||||
for which the root hub is the radio...To reiterate: it is a USB
|
||||
controller that is connected via USB instead of PCI.
|
||||
|
||||
*
|
||||
|
||||
*WINET*: some HW provide a WiNET interface (IP over UWB). This
|
||||
package provides a driver for it (it looks like a network
|
||||
interface, winetX). The driver detects when there is a link up for
|
||||
their type and kick into gear.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
DWA: Device Wired Adaptor, a Wireless USB hub for wired devices
|
||||
|
||||
These are the complement to HWAs. They are a USB host for connecting
|
||||
wired devices, but it is connected to your PC connected via Wireless
|
||||
USB. To the system it looks like yet another USB host. To the untrained
|
||||
eye, it looks like a hub that connects upstream wirelessly.
|
||||
|
||||
We still offer no support for this; however, it should share a lot of
|
||||
code with the HWA-RC driver; there is a bunch of factorization work that
|
||||
has been done to support that in upcoming releases.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
WHCI: Wireless Host Controller Interface, the PCI WUSB host adapter
|
||||
|
||||
This is your usual PCI device that implements WHCI. Similar in concept
|
||||
to EHCI, it allows your wireless USB devices (including DWAs) to connect
|
||||
to your host via a PCI interface. As in the case of the HWA, it has a
|
||||
Radio Control interface and the WUSB Host Controller interface per se.
|
||||
|
||||
There is still no driver support for this, but will be in upcoming
|
||||
releases.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
The UWB stack
|
||||
|
||||
The main mission of the UWB stack is to keep a tally of which devices
|
||||
are in radio proximity to allow drivers to connect to them. As well, it
|
||||
provides an API for controlling the local radio controllers (RCs from
|
||||
now on), such as to start/stop beaconing, scan, allocate bandwidth, etc.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Devices and hosts: the basic structure
|
||||
|
||||
The main building block here is the UWB device (struct uwb_dev). For
|
||||
each device that pops up in radio presence (ie: the UWB host receives a
|
||||
beacon from it) you get a struct uwb_dev that will show up in
|
||||
/sys/class/uwb and in /sys/bus/uwb/devices.
|
||||
|
||||
For each RC that is detected, a new struct uwb_rc is created. In turn, a
|
||||
RC is also a device, so they also show in /sys/class/uwb and
|
||||
/sys/bus/uwb/devices, but at the same time, only radio controllers show
|
||||
up in /sys/class/uwb_rc.
|
||||
|
||||
*
|
||||
|
||||
[*] The reason for RCs being also devices is that not only we can
|
||||
see them while enumerating the system device tree, but also on the
|
||||
radio (their beacons and stuff), so the handling has to be
|
||||
likewise to that of a device.
|
||||
|
||||
Each RC driver is implemented by a separate driver that plugs into the
|
||||
interface that the UWB stack provides through a struct uwb_rc_ops. The
|
||||
spec creators have been nice enough to make the message format the same
|
||||
for HWA and WHCI RCs, so the driver is really a very thin transport that
|
||||
moves the requests from the UWB API to the device [/uwb_rc_ops->cmd()/]
|
||||
and sends the replies and notifications back to the API
|
||||
[/uwb_rc_neh_grok()/]. Notifications are handled to the UWB daemon, that
|
||||
is chartered, among other things, to keep the tab of how the UWB radio
|
||||
neighborhood looks, creating and destroying devices as they show up or
|
||||
dissapear.
|
||||
|
||||
Command execution is very simple: a command block is sent and a event
|
||||
block or reply is expected back. For sending/receiving command/events, a
|
||||
handle called /neh/ (Notification/Event Handle) is opened with
|
||||
/uwb_rc_neh_open()/.
|
||||
|
||||
The HWA-RC (USB dongle) driver (drivers/uwb/hwa-rc.c) does this job for
|
||||
the USB connected HWA. Eventually, drivers/whci-rc.c will do the same
|
||||
for the PCI connected WHCI controller.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Host Controller life cycle
|
||||
|
||||
So let's say we connect a dongle to the system: it is detected and
|
||||
firmware uploaded if needed [for Intel's i1480
|
||||
/drivers/uwb/ptc/usb.c:ptc_usb_probe()/] and then it is reenumerated.
|
||||
Now we have a real HWA device connected and
|
||||
/drivers/uwb/hwa-rc.c:hwarc_probe()/ picks it up, that will set up the
|
||||
Wire-Adaptor environment and then suck it into the UWB stack's vision of
|
||||
the world [/drivers/uwb/lc-rc.c:uwb_rc_add()/].
|
||||
|
||||
*
|
||||
|
||||
[*] The stack should put a new RC to scan for devices
|
||||
[/uwb_rc_scan()/] so it finds what's available around and tries to
|
||||
connect to them, but this is policy stuff and should be driven
|
||||
from user space. As of now, the operator is expected to do it
|
||||
manually; see the release notes for documentation on the procedure.
|
||||
|
||||
When a dongle is disconnected, /drivers/uwb/hwa-rc.c:hwarc_disconnect()/
|
||||
takes time of tearing everything down safely (or not...).
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
On the air: beacons and enumerating the radio neighborhood
|
||||
|
||||
So assuming we have devices and we have agreed for a channel to connect
|
||||
on (let's say 9), we put the new RC to beacon:
|
||||
|
||||
*
|
||||
|
||||
$ echo 9 0 > /sys/class/uwb_rc/uwb0/beacon
|
||||
|
||||
Now it is visible. If there were other devices in the same radio channel
|
||||
and beacon group (that's what the zero is for), the dongle's radio
|
||||
control interface will send beacon notifications on its
|
||||
notification/event endpoint (NEEP). The beacon notifications are part of
|
||||
the event stream that is funneled into the API with
|
||||
/drivers/uwb/neh.c:uwb_rc_neh_grok()/ and delivered to the UWBD, the UWB
|
||||
daemon through a notification list.
|
||||
|
||||
UWBD wakes up and scans the event list; finds a beacon and adds it to
|
||||
the BEACON CACHE (/uwb_beca/). If he receives a number of beacons from
|
||||
the same device, he considers it to be 'onair' and creates a new device
|
||||
[/drivers/uwb/lc-dev.c:uwbd_dev_onair()/]. Similarly, when no beacons
|
||||
are received in some time, the device is considered gone and wiped out
|
||||
[uwbd calls periodically /uwb/beacon.c:uwb_beca_purge()/ that will purge
|
||||
the beacon cache of dead devices].
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Device lists
|
||||
|
||||
All UWB devices are kept in the list of the struct bus_type uwb_bus.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Bandwidth allocation
|
||||
|
||||
The UWB stack maintains a local copy of DRP availability through
|
||||
processing of incoming *DRP Availability Change* notifications. This
|
||||
local copy is currently used to present the current bandwidth
|
||||
availability to the user through the sysfs file
|
||||
/sys/class/uwb_rc/uwbx/bw_avail. In the future the bandwidth
|
||||
availability information will be used by the bandwidth reservation
|
||||
routines.
|
||||
|
||||
The bandwidth reservation routines are in progress and are thus not
|
||||
present in the current release. When completed they will enable a user
|
||||
to initiate DRP reservation requests through interaction with sysfs. DRP
|
||||
reservation requests from remote UWB devices will also be handled. The
|
||||
bandwidth management done by the UWB stack will include callbacks to the
|
||||
higher layers will enable the higher layers to use the reservations upon
|
||||
completion. [Note: The bandwidth reservation work is in progress and
|
||||
subject to change.]
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Wireless USB Host Controller drivers
|
||||
|
||||
*WARNING* This section needs a lot of work!
|
||||
|
||||
As explained above, there are three different types of HCs in the WUSB
|
||||
world: HWA-HC, DWA-HC and WHCI-HC.
|
||||
|
||||
HWA-HC and DWA-HC share that they are Wire-Adapters (USB or WUSB
|
||||
connected controllers), and their transfer management system is almost
|
||||
identical. So is their notification delivery system.
|
||||
|
||||
HWA-HC and WHCI-HC share that they are both WUSB host controllers, so
|
||||
they have to deal with WUSB device life cycle and maintenance, wireless
|
||||
root-hub
|
||||
|
||||
HWA exposes a Host Controller interface (HWA-HC 0xe0/02/02). This has
|
||||
three endpoints (Notifications, Data Transfer In and Data Transfer
|
||||
Out--known as NEP, DTI and DTO in the code).
|
||||
|
||||
We reserve UWB bandwidth for our Wireless USB Cluster, create a Cluster
|
||||
ID and tell the HC to use all that. Then we start it. This means the HC
|
||||
starts sending MMCs.
|
||||
|
||||
*
|
||||
|
||||
The MMCs are blocks of data defined somewhere in the WUSB1.0 spec
|
||||
that define a stream in the UWB channel time allocated for sending
|
||||
WUSB IEs (host to device commands/notifications) and Device
|
||||
Notifications (device initiated to host). Each host defines a
|
||||
unique Wireless USB cluster through MMCs. Devices can connect to a
|
||||
single cluster at the time. The IEs are Information Elements, and
|
||||
among them are the bandwidth allocations that tell each device
|
||||
when can they transmit or receive.
|
||||
|
||||
Now it all depends on external stimuli.
|
||||
|
||||
*New device connection*
|
||||
|
||||
A new device pops up, it scans the radio looking for MMCs that give out
|
||||
the existence of Wireless USB channels. Once one (or more) are found,
|
||||
selects which one to connect to. Sends a /DN_Connect/ (device
|
||||
notification connect) during the DNTS (Device Notification Time
|
||||
Slot--announced in the MMCs
|
||||
|
||||
HC picks the /DN_Connect/ out (nep module sends to notif.c for delivery
|
||||
into /devconnect/). This process starts the authentication process for
|
||||
the device. First we allocate a /fake port/ and assign an
|
||||
unauthenticated address (128 to 255--what we really do is
|
||||
0x80 | fake_port_idx). We fiddle with the fake port status and /khubd/
|
||||
sees a new connection, so he moves on to enable the fake port with a reset.
|
||||
|
||||
So now we are in the reset path -- we know we have a non-yet enumerated
|
||||
device with an unauthorized address; we ask user space to authenticate
|
||||
(FIXME: not yet done, similar to bluetooth pairing), then we do the key
|
||||
exchange (FIXME: not yet done) and issue a /set address 0/ to bring the
|
||||
device to the default state. Device is authenticated.
|
||||
|
||||
From here, the USB stack takes control through the usb_hcd ops. khubd
|
||||
has seen the port status changes, as we have been toggling them. It will
|
||||
start enumerating and doing transfers through usb_hcd->urb_enqueue() to
|
||||
read descriptors and move our data.
|
||||
|
||||
*Device life cycle and keep alives*
|
||||
|
||||
Everytime there is a succesful transfer to/from a device, we update a
|
||||
per-device activity timestamp. If not, every now and then we check and
|
||||
if the activity timestamp gets old, we ping the device by sending it a
|
||||
Keep Alive IE; it responds with a /DN_Alive/ pong during the DNTS (this
|
||||
arrives to us as a notification through
|
||||
devconnect.c:wusb_handle_dn_alive(). If a device times out, we
|
||||
disconnect it from the system (cleaning up internal information and
|
||||
toggling the bits in the fake hub port, which kicks khubd into removing
|
||||
the rest of the stuff).
|
||||
|
||||
This is done through devconnect:__wusb_check_devs(), which will scan the
|
||||
device list looking for whom needs refreshing.
|
||||
|
||||
If the device wants to disconnect, it will either die (ugly) or send a
|
||||
/DN_Disconnect/ that will prompt a disconnection from the system.
|
||||
|
||||
*Sending and receiving data*
|
||||
|
||||
Data is sent and received through /Remote Pipes/ (rpipes). An rpipe is
|
||||
/aimed/ at an endpoint in a WUSB device. This is the same for HWAs and
|
||||
DWAs.
|
||||
|
||||
Each HC has a number of rpipes and buffers that can be assigned to them;
|
||||
when doing a data transfer (xfer), first the rpipe has to be aimed and
|
||||
prepared (buffers assigned), then we can start queueing requests for
|
||||
data in or out.
|
||||
|
||||
Data buffers have to be segmented out before sending--so we send first a
|
||||
header (segment request) and then if there is any data, a data buffer
|
||||
immediately after to the DTI interface (yep, even the request). If our
|
||||
buffer is bigger than the max segment size, then we just do multiple
|
||||
requests.
|
||||
|
||||
[This sucks, because doing USB scatter gatter in Linux is resource
|
||||
intensive, if any...not that the current approach is not. It just has to
|
||||
be cleaned up a lot :)].
|
||||
|
||||
If reading, we don't send data buffers, just the segment headers saying
|
||||
we want to read segments.
|
||||
|
||||
When the xfer is executed, we receive a notification that says data is
|
||||
ready in the DTI endpoint (handled through
|
||||
xfer.c:wa_handle_notif_xfer()). In there we read from the DTI endpoint a
|
||||
descriptor that gives us the status of the transfer, its identification
|
||||
(given when we issued it) and the segment number. If it was a data read,
|
||||
we issue another URB to read into the destination buffer the chunk of
|
||||
data coming out of the remote endpoint. Done, wait for the next guy. The
|
||||
callbacks for the URBs issued from here are the ones that will declare
|
||||
the xfer complete at some point and call it's callback.
|
||||
|
||||
Seems simple, but the implementation is not trivial.
|
||||
|
||||
*
|
||||
|
||||
*WARNING* Old!!
|
||||
|
||||
The main xfer descriptor, wa_xfer (equivalent to a URB) contains an
|
||||
array of segments, tallys on segments and buffers and callback
|
||||
information. Buried in there is a lot of URBs for executing the segments
|
||||
and buffer transfers.
|
||||
|
||||
For OUT xfers, there is an array of segments, one URB for each, another
|
||||
one of buffer URB. When submitting, we submit URBs for segment request
|
||||
1, buffer 1, segment 2, buffer 2...etc. Then we wait on the DTI for xfer
|
||||
result data; when all the segments are complete, we call the callback to
|
||||
finalize the transfer.
|
||||
|
||||
For IN xfers, we only issue URBs for the segments we want to read and
|
||||
then wait for the xfer result data.
|
||||
|
||||
*URB mapping into xfers*
|
||||
|
||||
This is done by hwahc_op_urb_[en|de]queue(). In enqueue() we aim an
|
||||
rpipe to the endpoint where we have to transmit, create a transfer
|
||||
context (wa_xfer) and submit it. When the xfer is done, our callback is
|
||||
called and we assign the status bits and release the xfer resources.
|
||||
|
||||
In dequeue() we are basically cancelling/aborting the transfer. We issue
|
||||
a xfer abort request to the HC, cancell all the URBs we had submitted
|
||||
and not yet done and when all that is done, the xfer callback will be
|
||||
called--this will call the URB callback.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Glossary
|
||||
|
||||
*DWA* -- Device Wire Adapter
|
||||
|
||||
USB host, wired for downstream devices, upstream connects wirelessly
|
||||
with Wireless USB.
|
||||
|
||||
*EVENT* -- Response to a command on the NEEP
|
||||
|
||||
*HWA* -- Host Wire Adapter / USB dongle for UWB and Wireless USB
|
||||
|
||||
*NEH* -- Notification/Event Handle
|
||||
|
||||
Handle/file descriptor for receiving notifications or events. The WA
|
||||
code requires you to get one of this to listen for notifications or
|
||||
events on the NEEP.
|
||||
|
||||
*NEEP* -- Notification/Event EndPoint
|
||||
|
||||
Stuff related to the management of the first endpoint of a HWA USB
|
||||
dongle that is used to deliver an stream of events and notifications to
|
||||
the host.
|
||||
|
||||
*NOTIFICATION* -- Message coming in the NEEP as response to something.
|
||||
|
||||
*RC* -- Radio Control
|
||||
|
||||
Design-overview.txt-1.8 (last edited 2006-11-04 12:22:24 by
|
||||
InakyPerezGonzalez)
|
||||
|
|
@ -52,6 +52,11 @@ Therefore no guarantee is made that the URBs have been unlinked when
|
|||
the call returns. They may be unlinked later but will be unlinked in
|
||||
finite time.
|
||||
|
||||
usb_scuttle_anchored_urbs()
|
||||
---------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
All URBs of an anchor are unanchored en masse.
|
||||
|
||||
usb_wait_anchor_empty_timeout()
|
||||
-------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -59,4 +64,16 @@ This function waits for all URBs associated with an anchor to finish
|
|||
or a timeout, whichever comes first. Its return value will tell you
|
||||
whether the timeout was reached.
|
||||
|
||||
usb_anchor_empty()
|
||||
------------------
|
||||
|
||||
Returns true if no URBs are associated with an anchor. Locking
|
||||
is the caller's responsibility.
|
||||
|
||||
usb_get_from_anchor()
|
||||
---------------------
|
||||
|
||||
Returns the oldest anchored URB of an anchor. The URB is unanchored
|
||||
and returned with a reference. As you may mix URBs to several
|
||||
destinations in one anchor you have no guarantee the chronologically
|
||||
first submitted URB is returned.
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,46 @@
|
|||
USB 7-Segment Numeric Display
|
||||
Manufactured by Delcom Engineering
|
||||
|
||||
Device Information
|
||||
------------------
|
||||
USB VENDOR_ID 0x0fc5
|
||||
USB PRODUCT_ID 0x1227
|
||||
Both the 6 character and 8 character displays have PRODUCT_ID,
|
||||
and according to Delcom Engineering no queryable information
|
||||
can be obtained from the device to tell them apart.
|
||||
|
||||
Device Modes
|
||||
------------
|
||||
By default, the driver assumes the display is only 6 characters
|
||||
The mode for 6 characters is:
|
||||
MSB 0x06; LSB 0x3f
|
||||
For the 8 character display:
|
||||
MSB 0x08; LSB 0xff
|
||||
The device can accept "text" either in raw, hex, or ascii textmode.
|
||||
raw controls each segment manually,
|
||||
hex expects a value between 0-15 per character,
|
||||
ascii expects a value between '0'-'9' and 'A'-'F'.
|
||||
The default is ascii.
|
||||
|
||||
Device Operation
|
||||
----------------
|
||||
1. Turn on the device:
|
||||
echo 1 > /sys/bus/usb/.../powered
|
||||
2. Set the device's mode:
|
||||
echo $mode_msb > /sys/bus/usb/.../mode_msb
|
||||
echo $mode_lsb > /sys/bus/usb/.../mode_lsb
|
||||
3. Set the textmode:
|
||||
echo $textmode > /sys/bus/usb/.../textmode
|
||||
4. set the text (for example):
|
||||
echo "123ABC" > /sys/bus/usb/.../text (ascii)
|
||||
echo "A1B2" > /sys/bus/usb/.../text (ascii)
|
||||
echo -ne "\x01\x02\x03" > /sys/bus/usb/.../text (hex)
|
||||
5. Set the decimal places.
|
||||
The device has either 6 or 8 decimal points.
|
||||
to set the nth decimal place calculate 10 ** n
|
||||
and echo it in to /sys/bus/usb/.../decimals
|
||||
To set multiple decimals points sum up each power.
|
||||
For example, to set the 0th and 3rd decimal place
|
||||
echo 1001 > /sys/bus/usb/.../decimals
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
@ -350,12 +350,12 @@ without holding the mutex.
|
|||
|
||||
There also are a couple of utility routines drivers can use:
|
||||
|
||||
usb_autopm_enable() sets pm_usage_cnt to 1 and then calls
|
||||
usb_autopm_set_interface(), which will attempt an autoresume.
|
||||
|
||||
usb_autopm_disable() sets pm_usage_cnt to 0 and then calls
|
||||
usb_autopm_enable() sets pm_usage_cnt to 0 and then calls
|
||||
usb_autopm_set_interface(), which will attempt an autosuspend.
|
||||
|
||||
usb_autopm_disable() sets pm_usage_cnt to 1 and then calls
|
||||
usb_autopm_set_interface(), which will attempt an autoresume.
|
||||
|
||||
The conventional usage pattern is that a driver calls
|
||||
usb_autopm_get_interface() in its open routine and
|
||||
usb_autopm_put_interface() in its close or release routine. But
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,139 @@
|
|||
#! /bin/bash
|
||||
#
|
||||
|
||||
set -e
|
||||
|
||||
progname=$(basename $0)
|
||||
function help
|
||||
{
|
||||
cat <<EOF
|
||||
Usage: $progname COMMAND DEVICEs [ARGS]
|
||||
|
||||
Command for manipulating the pairing/authentication credentials of a
|
||||
Wireless USB device that supports wired-mode Cable-Based-Association.
|
||||
|
||||
Works in conjunction with the wusb-cba.ko driver from http://linuxuwb.org.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
DEVICE
|
||||
|
||||
sysfs path to the device to authenticate; for example, both this
|
||||
guys are the same:
|
||||
|
||||
/sys/devices/pci0000:00/0000:00:1d.7/usb1/1-4/1-4.4/1-4.4:1.1
|
||||
/sys/bus/usb/drivers/wusb-cbaf/1-4.4:1.1
|
||||
|
||||
COMMAND/ARGS are
|
||||
|
||||
start
|
||||
|
||||
Start a WUSB host controller (by setting up a CHID)
|
||||
|
||||
set-chid DEVICE HOST-CHID HOST-BANDGROUP HOST-NAME
|
||||
|
||||
Sets host information in the device; after this you can call the
|
||||
get-cdid to see how does this device report itself to us.
|
||||
|
||||
get-cdid DEVICE
|
||||
|
||||
Get the device ID associated to the HOST-CHDI we sent with
|
||||
'set-chid'. We might not know about it.
|
||||
|
||||
set-cc DEVICE
|
||||
|
||||
If we allow the device to connect, set a random new CDID and CK
|
||||
(connection key). Device saves them for the next time it wants to
|
||||
connect wireless. We save them for that next time also so we can
|
||||
authenticate the device (when we see the CDID he uses to id
|
||||
itself) and the CK to crypto talk to it.
|
||||
|
||||
CHID is always 16 hex bytes in 'XX YY ZZ...' form
|
||||
BANDGROUP is almost always 0001
|
||||
|
||||
Examples:
|
||||
|
||||
You can default most arguments to '' to get a sane value:
|
||||
|
||||
$ $progname set-chid '' '' '' "My host name"
|
||||
|
||||
A full sequence:
|
||||
|
||||
$ $progname set-chid '' '' '' "My host name"
|
||||
$ $progname get-cdid ''
|
||||
$ $progname set-cc ''
|
||||
|
||||
EOF
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
# Defaults
|
||||
# FIXME: CHID should come from a database :), band group from the host
|
||||
host_CHID="00 11 22 33 44 55 66 77 88 99 aa bb cc dd ee ff"
|
||||
host_band_group="0001"
|
||||
host_name=$(hostname)
|
||||
|
||||
devs="$(echo /sys/bus/usb/drivers/wusb-cbaf/[0-9]*)"
|
||||
hdevs="$(for h in /sys/class/uwb_rc/*/wusbhc; do readlink -f $h; done)"
|
||||
|
||||
result=0
|
||||
case $1 in
|
||||
start)
|
||||
for dev in ${2:-$hdevs}
|
||||
do
|
||||
uwb_rc=$(readlink -f $dev/uwb_rc)
|
||||
if cat $uwb_rc/beacon | grep -q -- "-1"
|
||||
then
|
||||
echo 13 0 > $uwb_rc/beacon
|
||||
echo I: started beaconing on ch 13 on $(basename $uwb_rc) >&2
|
||||
fi
|
||||
echo $host_CHID > $dev/wusb_chid
|
||||
echo I: started host $(basename $dev) >&2
|
||||
done
|
||||
;;
|
||||
stop)
|
||||
for dev in ${2:-$hdevs}
|
||||
do
|
||||
echo 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 > $dev/wusb_chid
|
||||
echo I: stopped host $(basename $dev) >&2
|
||||
uwb_rc=$(readlink -f $dev/uwb_rc)
|
||||
echo -1 | cat > $uwb_rc/beacon
|
||||
echo I: stopped beaconing on $(basename $uwb_rc) >&2
|
||||
done
|
||||
;;
|
||||
set-chid)
|
||||
shift
|
||||
for dev in ${2:-$devs}; do
|
||||
echo "${4:-$host_name}" > $dev/wusb_host_name
|
||||
echo "${3:-$host_band_group}" > $dev/wusb_host_band_groups
|
||||
echo ${2:-$host_CHID} > $dev/wusb_chid
|
||||
done
|
||||
;;
|
||||
get-cdid)
|
||||
for dev in ${2:-$devs}
|
||||
do
|
||||
cat $dev/wusb_cdid
|
||||
done
|
||||
;;
|
||||
set-cc)
|
||||
for dev in ${2:-$devs}; do
|
||||
shift
|
||||
CDID="$(head --bytes=16 /dev/urandom | od -tx1 -An)"
|
||||
CK="$(head --bytes=16 /dev/urandom | od -tx1 -An)"
|
||||
echo "$CDID" > $dev/wusb_cdid
|
||||
echo "$CK" > $dev/wusb_ck
|
||||
|
||||
echo I: CC set >&2
|
||||
echo "CHID: $(cat $dev/wusb_chid)"
|
||||
echo "CDID:$CDID"
|
||||
echo "CK: $CK"
|
||||
done
|
||||
;;
|
||||
help|h|--help|-h)
|
||||
help
|
||||
;;
|
||||
*)
|
||||
echo "E: Unknown usage" 1>&2
|
||||
help 1>&2
|
||||
result=1
|
||||
esac
|
||||
exit $result
|
|
@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
|
|||
0 -> Unknown board (au0828)
|
||||
1 -> Hauppauge HVR950Q (au0828) [2040:7200,2040:7210,2040:7217,2040:721b,2040:721f,2040:7280,0fd9:0008]
|
||||
1 -> Hauppauge HVR950Q (au0828) [2040:7200,2040:7210,2040:7217,2040:721b,2040:721e,2040:721f,2040:7280,0fd9:0008]
|
||||
2 -> Hauppauge HVR850 (au0828) [2040:7240]
|
||||
3 -> DViCO FusionHDTV USB (au0828) [0fe9:d620]
|
||||
4 -> Hauppauge HVR950Q rev xxF8 (au0828) [2040:7201,2040:7211,2040:7281]
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -75,3 +75,4 @@ tuner=73 - Samsung TCPG 6121P30A
|
|||
tuner=75 - Philips TEA5761 FM Radio
|
||||
tuner=76 - Xceive 5000 tuner
|
||||
tuner=77 - TCL tuner MF02GIP-5N-E
|
||||
tuner=78 - Philips FMD1216MEX MK3 Hybrid Tuner
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,615 @@
|
|||
|
||||
This document describes the Linux memory management "Unevictable LRU"
|
||||
infrastructure and the use of this infrastructure to manage several types
|
||||
of "unevictable" pages. The document attempts to provide the overall
|
||||
rationale behind this mechanism and the rationale for some of the design
|
||||
decisions that drove the implementation. The latter design rationale is
|
||||
discussed in the context of an implementation description. Admittedly, one
|
||||
can obtain the implementation details--the "what does it do?"--by reading the
|
||||
code. One hopes that the descriptions below add value by provide the answer
|
||||
to "why does it do that?".
|
||||
|
||||
Unevictable LRU Infrastructure:
|
||||
|
||||
The Unevictable LRU adds an additional LRU list to track unevictable pages
|
||||
and to hide these pages from vmscan. This mechanism is based on a patch by
|
||||
Larry Woodman of Red Hat to address several scalability problems with page
|
||||
reclaim in Linux. The problems have been observed at customer sites on large
|
||||
memory x86_64 systems. For example, a non-numal x86_64 platform with 128GB
|
||||
of main memory will have over 32 million 4k pages in a single zone. When a
|
||||
large fraction of these pages are not evictable for any reason [see below],
|
||||
vmscan will spend a lot of time scanning the LRU lists looking for the small
|
||||
fraction of pages that are evictable. This can result in a situation where
|
||||
all cpus are spending 100% of their time in vmscan for hours or days on end,
|
||||
with the system completely unresponsive.
|
||||
|
||||
The Unevictable LRU infrastructure addresses the following classes of
|
||||
unevictable pages:
|
||||
|
||||
+ page owned by ramfs
|
||||
+ page mapped into SHM_LOCKed shared memory regions
|
||||
+ page mapped into VM_LOCKED [mlock()ed] vmas
|
||||
|
||||
The infrastructure might be able to handle other conditions that make pages
|
||||
unevictable, either by definition or by circumstance, in the future.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
The Unevictable LRU List
|
||||
|
||||
The Unevictable LRU infrastructure consists of an additional, per-zone, LRU list
|
||||
called the "unevictable" list and an associated page flag, PG_unevictable, to
|
||||
indicate that the page is being managed on the unevictable list. The
|
||||
PG_unevictable flag is analogous to, and mutually exclusive with, the PG_active
|
||||
flag in that it indicates on which LRU list a page resides when PG_lru is set.
|
||||
The unevictable LRU list is source configurable based on the UNEVICTABLE_LRU
|
||||
Kconfig option.
|
||||
|
||||
The Unevictable LRU infrastructure maintains unevictable pages on an additional
|
||||
LRU list for a few reasons:
|
||||
|
||||
1) We get to "treat unevictable pages just like we treat other pages in the
|
||||
system, which means we get to use the same code to manipulate them, the
|
||||
same code to isolate them (for migrate, etc.), the same code to keep track
|
||||
of the statistics, etc..." [Rik van Riel]
|
||||
|
||||
2) We want to be able to migrate unevictable pages between nodes--for memory
|
||||
defragmentation, workload management and memory hotplug. The linux kernel
|
||||
can only migrate pages that it can successfully isolate from the lru lists.
|
||||
If we were to maintain pages elsewise than on an lru-like list, where they
|
||||
can be found by isolate_lru_page(), we would prevent their migration, unless
|
||||
we reworked migration code to find the unevictable pages.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
The unevictable LRU list does not differentiate between file backed and swap
|
||||
backed [anon] pages. This differentiation is only important while the pages
|
||||
are, in fact, evictable.
|
||||
|
||||
The unevictable LRU list benefits from the "arrayification" of the per-zone
|
||||
LRU lists and statistics originally proposed and posted by Christoph Lameter.
|
||||
|
||||
The unevictable list does not use the lru pagevec mechanism. Rather,
|
||||
unevictable pages are placed directly on the page's zone's unevictable
|
||||
list under the zone lru_lock. The reason for this is to prevent stranding
|
||||
of pages on the unevictable list when one task has the page isolated from the
|
||||
lru and other tasks are changing the "evictability" state of the page.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Unevictable LRU and Memory Controller Interaction
|
||||
|
||||
The memory controller data structure automatically gets a per zone unevictable
|
||||
lru list as a result of the "arrayification" of the per-zone LRU lists. The
|
||||
memory controller tracks the movement of pages to and from the unevictable list.
|
||||
When a memory control group comes under memory pressure, the controller will
|
||||
not attempt to reclaim pages on the unevictable list. This has a couple of
|
||||
effects. Because the pages are "hidden" from reclaim on the unevictable list,
|
||||
the reclaim process can be more efficient, dealing only with pages that have
|
||||
a chance of being reclaimed. On the other hand, if too many of the pages
|
||||
charged to the control group are unevictable, the evictable portion of the
|
||||
working set of the tasks in the control group may not fit into the available
|
||||
memory. This can cause the control group to thrash or to oom-kill tasks.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Unevictable LRU: Detecting Unevictable Pages
|
||||
|
||||
The function page_evictable(page, vma) in vmscan.c determines whether a
|
||||
page is evictable or not. For ramfs pages and pages in SHM_LOCKed regions,
|
||||
page_evictable() tests a new address space flag, AS_UNEVICTABLE, in the page's
|
||||
address space using a wrapper function. Wrapper functions are used to set,
|
||||
clear and test the flag to reduce the requirement for #ifdef's throughout the
|
||||
source code. AS_UNEVICTABLE is set on ramfs inode/mapping when it is created.
|
||||
This flag remains for the life of the inode.
|
||||
|
||||
For shared memory regions, AS_UNEVICTABLE is set when an application
|
||||
successfully SHM_LOCKs the region and is removed when the region is
|
||||
SHM_UNLOCKed. Note that shmctl(SHM_LOCK, ...) does not populate the page
|
||||
tables for the region as does, for example, mlock(). So, we make no special
|
||||
effort to push any pages in the SHM_LOCKed region to the unevictable list.
|
||||
Vmscan will do this when/if it encounters the pages during reclaim. On
|
||||
SHM_UNLOCK, shmctl() scans the pages in the region and "rescues" them from the
|
||||
unevictable list if no other condition keeps them unevictable. If a SHM_LOCKed
|
||||
region is destroyed, the pages are also "rescued" from the unevictable list in
|
||||
the process of freeing them.
|
||||
|
||||
page_evictable() detects mlock()ed pages by testing an additional page flag,
|
||||
PG_mlocked via the PageMlocked() wrapper. If the page is NOT mlocked, and a
|
||||
non-NULL vma is supplied, page_evictable() will check whether the vma is
|
||||
VM_LOCKED via is_mlocked_vma(). is_mlocked_vma() will SetPageMlocked() and
|
||||
update the appropriate statistics if the vma is VM_LOCKED. This method allows
|
||||
efficient "culling" of pages in the fault path that are being faulted in to
|
||||
VM_LOCKED vmas.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Unevictable Pages and Vmscan [shrink_*_list()]
|
||||
|
||||
If unevictable pages are culled in the fault path, or moved to the unevictable
|
||||
list at mlock() or mmap() time, vmscan will never encounter the pages until
|
||||
they have become evictable again, for example, via munlock() and have been
|
||||
"rescued" from the unevictable list. However, there may be situations where we
|
||||
decide, for the sake of expediency, to leave a unevictable page on one of the
|
||||
regular active/inactive LRU lists for vmscan to deal with. Vmscan checks for
|
||||
such pages in all of the shrink_{active|inactive|page}_list() functions and
|
||||
will "cull" such pages that it encounters--that is, it diverts those pages to
|
||||
the unevictable list for the zone being scanned.
|
||||
|
||||
There may be situations where a page is mapped into a VM_LOCKED vma, but the
|
||||
page is not marked as PageMlocked. Such pages will make it all the way to
|
||||
shrink_page_list() where they will be detected when vmscan walks the reverse
|
||||
map in try_to_unmap(). If try_to_unmap() returns SWAP_MLOCK, shrink_page_list()
|
||||
will cull the page at that point.
|
||||
|
||||
Note that for anonymous pages, shrink_page_list() attempts to add the page to
|
||||
the swap cache before it tries to unmap the page. To avoid this unnecessary
|
||||
consumption of swap space, shrink_page_list() calls try_to_munlock() to check
|
||||
whether any VM_LOCKED vmas map the page without attempting to unmap the page.
|
||||
If try_to_munlock() returns SWAP_MLOCK, shrink_page_list() will cull the page
|
||||
without consuming swap space. try_to_munlock() will be described below.
|
||||
|
||||
To "cull" an unevictable page, vmscan simply puts the page back on the lru
|
||||
list using putback_lru_page()--the inverse operation to isolate_lru_page()--
|
||||
after dropping the page lock. Because the condition which makes the page
|
||||
unevictable may change once the page is unlocked, putback_lru_page() will
|
||||
recheck the unevictable state of a page that it places on the unevictable lru
|
||||
list. If the page has become unevictable, putback_lru_page() removes it from
|
||||
the list and retries, including the page_unevictable() test. Because such a
|
||||
race is a rare event and movement of pages onto the unevictable list should be
|
||||
rare, these extra evictabilty checks should not occur in the majority of calls
|
||||
to putback_lru_page().
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Mlocked Page: Prior Work
|
||||
|
||||
The "Unevictable Mlocked Pages" infrastructure is based on work originally
|
||||
posted by Nick Piggin in an RFC patch entitled "mm: mlocked pages off LRU".
|
||||
Nick posted his patch as an alternative to a patch posted by Christoph
|
||||
Lameter to achieve the same objective--hiding mlocked pages from vmscan.
|
||||
In Nick's patch, he used one of the struct page lru list link fields as a count
|
||||
of VM_LOCKED vmas that map the page. This use of the link field for a count
|
||||
prevented the management of the pages on an LRU list. Thus, mlocked pages were
|
||||
not migratable as isolate_lru_page() could not find them and the lru list link
|
||||
field was not available to the migration subsystem. Nick resolved this by
|
||||
putting mlocked pages back on the lru list before attempting to isolate them,
|
||||
thus abandoning the count of VM_LOCKED vmas. When Nick's patch was integrated
|
||||
with the Unevictable LRU work, the count was replaced by walking the reverse
|
||||
map to determine whether any VM_LOCKED vmas mapped the page. More on this
|
||||
below.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Mlocked Pages: Basic Management
|
||||
|
||||
Mlocked pages--pages mapped into a VM_LOCKED vma--represent one class of
|
||||
unevictable pages. When such a page has been "noticed" by the memory
|
||||
management subsystem, the page is marked with the PG_mlocked [PageMlocked()]
|
||||
flag. A PageMlocked() page will be placed on the unevictable LRU list when
|
||||
it is added to the LRU. Pages can be "noticed" by memory management in
|
||||
several places:
|
||||
|
||||
1) in the mlock()/mlockall() system call handlers.
|
||||
2) in the mmap() system call handler when mmap()ing a region with the
|
||||
MAP_LOCKED flag, or mmap()ing a region in a task that has called
|
||||
mlockall() with the MCL_FUTURE flag. Both of these conditions result
|
||||
in the VM_LOCKED flag being set for the vma.
|
||||
3) in the fault path, if mlocked pages are "culled" in the fault path,
|
||||
and when a VM_LOCKED stack segment is expanded.
|
||||
4) as mentioned above, in vmscan:shrink_page_list() with attempting to
|
||||
reclaim a page in a VM_LOCKED vma--via try_to_unmap() or try_to_munlock().
|
||||
|
||||
Mlocked pages become unlocked and rescued from the unevictable list when:
|
||||
|
||||
1) mapped in a range unlocked via the munlock()/munlockall() system calls.
|
||||
2) munmapped() out of the last VM_LOCKED vma that maps the page, including
|
||||
unmapping at task exit.
|
||||
3) when the page is truncated from the last VM_LOCKED vma of an mmap()ed file.
|
||||
4) before a page is COWed in a VM_LOCKED vma.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Mlocked Pages: mlock()/mlockall() System Call Handling
|
||||
|
||||
Both [do_]mlock() and [do_]mlockall() system call handlers call mlock_fixup()
|
||||
for each vma in the range specified by the call. In the case of mlockall(),
|
||||
this is the entire active address space of the task. Note that mlock_fixup()
|
||||
is used for both mlock()ing and munlock()ing a range of memory. A call to
|
||||
mlock() an already VM_LOCKED vma, or to munlock() a vma that is not VM_LOCKED
|
||||
is treated as a no-op--mlock_fixup() simply returns.
|
||||
|
||||
If the vma passes some filtering described in "Mlocked Pages: Filtering Vmas"
|
||||
below, mlock_fixup() will attempt to merge the vma with its neighbors or split
|
||||
off a subset of the vma if the range does not cover the entire vma. Once the
|
||||
vma has been merged or split or neither, mlock_fixup() will call
|
||||
__mlock_vma_pages_range() to fault in the pages via get_user_pages() and
|
||||
to mark the pages as mlocked via mlock_vma_page().
|
||||
|
||||
Note that the vma being mlocked might be mapped with PROT_NONE. In this case,
|
||||
get_user_pages() will be unable to fault in the pages. That's OK. If pages
|
||||
do end up getting faulted into this VM_LOCKED vma, we'll handle them in the
|
||||
fault path or in vmscan.
|
||||
|
||||
Also note that a page returned by get_user_pages() could be truncated or
|
||||
migrated out from under us, while we're trying to mlock it. To detect
|
||||
this, __mlock_vma_pages_range() tests the page_mapping after acquiring
|
||||
the page lock. If the page is still associated with its mapping, we'll
|
||||
go ahead and call mlock_vma_page(). If the mapping is gone, we just
|
||||
unlock the page and move on. Worse case, this results in page mapped
|
||||
in a VM_LOCKED vma remaining on a normal LRU list without being
|
||||
PageMlocked(). Again, vmscan will detect and cull such pages.
|
||||
|
||||
mlock_vma_page(), called with the page locked [N.B., not "mlocked"], will
|
||||
TestSetPageMlocked() for each page returned by get_user_pages(). We use
|
||||
TestSetPageMlocked() because the page might already be mlocked by another
|
||||
task/vma and we don't want to do extra work. We especially do not want to
|
||||
count an mlocked page more than once in the statistics. If the page was
|
||||
already mlocked, mlock_vma_page() is done.
|
||||
|
||||
If the page was NOT already mlocked, mlock_vma_page() attempts to isolate the
|
||||
page from the LRU, as it is likely on the appropriate active or inactive list
|
||||
at that time. If the isolate_lru_page() succeeds, mlock_vma_page() will
|
||||
putback the page--putback_lru_page()--which will notice that the page is now
|
||||
mlocked and divert the page to the zone's unevictable LRU list. If
|
||||
mlock_vma_page() is unable to isolate the page from the LRU, vmscan will handle
|
||||
it later if/when it attempts to reclaim the page.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Mlocked Pages: Filtering Special Vmas
|
||||
|
||||
mlock_fixup() filters several classes of "special" vmas:
|
||||
|
||||
1) vmas with VM_IO|VM_PFNMAP set are skipped entirely. The pages behind
|
||||
these mappings are inherently pinned, so we don't need to mark them as
|
||||
mlocked. In any case, most of the pages have no struct page in which to
|
||||
so mark the page. Because of this, get_user_pages() will fail for these
|
||||
vmas, so there is no sense in attempting to visit them.
|
||||
|
||||
2) vmas mapping hugetlbfs page are already effectively pinned into memory.
|
||||
We don't need nor want to mlock() these pages. However, to preserve the
|
||||
prior behavior of mlock()--before the unevictable/mlock changes--mlock_fixup()
|
||||
will call make_pages_present() in the hugetlbfs vma range to allocate the
|
||||
huge pages and populate the ptes.
|
||||
|
||||
3) vmas with VM_DONTEXPAND|VM_RESERVED are generally user space mappings of
|
||||
kernel pages, such as the vdso page, relay channel pages, etc. These pages
|
||||
are inherently unevictable and are not managed on the LRU lists.
|
||||
mlock_fixup() treats these vmas the same as hugetlbfs vmas. It calls
|
||||
make_pages_present() to populate the ptes.
|
||||
|
||||
Note that for all of these special vmas, mlock_fixup() does not set the
|
||||
VM_LOCKED flag. Therefore, we won't have to deal with them later during
|
||||
munlock() or munmap()--for example, at task exit. Neither does mlock_fixup()
|
||||
account these vmas against the task's "locked_vm".
|
||||
|
||||
Mlocked Pages: Downgrading the Mmap Semaphore.
|
||||
|
||||
mlock_fixup() must be called with the mmap semaphore held for write, because
|
||||
it may have to merge or split vmas. However, mlocking a large region of
|
||||
memory can take a long time--especially if vmscan must reclaim pages to
|
||||
satisfy the regions requirements. Faulting in a large region with the mmap
|
||||
semaphore held for write can hold off other faults on the address space, in
|
||||
the case of a multi-threaded task. It can also hold off scans of the task's
|
||||
address space via /proc. While testing under heavy load, it was observed that
|
||||
the ps(1) command could be held off for many minutes while a large segment was
|
||||
mlock()ed down.
|
||||
|
||||
To address this issue, and to make the system more responsive during mlock()ing
|
||||
of large segments, mlock_fixup() downgrades the mmap semaphore to read mode
|
||||
during the call to __mlock_vma_pages_range(). This works fine. However, the
|
||||
callers of mlock_fixup() expect the semaphore to be returned in write mode.
|
||||
So, mlock_fixup() "upgrades" the semphore to write mode. Linux does not
|
||||
support an atomic upgrade_sem() call, so mlock_fixup() must drop the semaphore
|
||||
and reacquire it in write mode. In a multi-threaded task, it is possible for
|
||||
the task memory map to change while the semaphore is dropped. Therefore,
|
||||
mlock_fixup() looks up the vma at the range start address after reacquiring
|
||||
the semaphore in write mode and verifies that it still covers the original
|
||||
range. If not, mlock_fixup() returns an error [-EAGAIN]. All callers of
|
||||
mlock_fixup() have been changed to deal with this new error condition.
|
||||
|
||||
Note: when munlocking a region, all of the pages should already be resident--
|
||||
unless we have racing threads mlocking() and munlocking() regions. So,
|
||||
unlocking should not have to wait for page allocations nor faults of any kind.
|
||||
Therefore mlock_fixup() does not downgrade the semaphore for munlock().
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Mlocked Pages: munlock()/munlockall() System Call Handling
|
||||
|
||||
The munlock() and munlockall() system calls are handled by the same functions--
|
||||
do_mlock[all]()--as the mlock() and mlockall() system calls with the unlock
|
||||
vs lock operation indicated by an argument. So, these system calls are also
|
||||
handled by mlock_fixup(). Again, if called for an already munlock()ed vma,
|
||||
mlock_fixup() simply returns. Because of the vma filtering discussed above,
|
||||
VM_LOCKED will not be set in any "special" vmas. So, these vmas will be
|
||||
ignored for munlock.
|
||||
|
||||
If the vma is VM_LOCKED, mlock_fixup() again attempts to merge or split off
|
||||
the specified range. The range is then munlocked via the function
|
||||
__mlock_vma_pages_range()--the same function used to mlock a vma range--
|
||||
passing a flag to indicate that munlock() is being performed.
|
||||
|
||||
Because the vma access protections could have been changed to PROT_NONE after
|
||||
faulting in and mlocking some pages, get_user_pages() was unreliable for visiting
|
||||
these pages for munlocking. Because we don't want to leave pages mlocked(),
|
||||
get_user_pages() was enhanced to accept a flag to ignore the permissions when
|
||||
fetching the pages--all of which should be resident as a result of previous
|
||||
mlock()ing.
|
||||
|
||||
For munlock(), __mlock_vma_pages_range() unlocks individual pages by calling
|
||||
munlock_vma_page(). munlock_vma_page() unconditionally clears the PG_mlocked
|
||||
flag using TestClearPageMlocked(). As with mlock_vma_page(), munlock_vma_page()
|
||||
use the Test*PageMlocked() function to handle the case where the page might
|
||||
have already been unlocked by another task. If the page was mlocked,
|
||||
munlock_vma_page() updates that zone statistics for the number of mlocked
|
||||
pages. Note, however, that at this point we haven't checked whether the page
|
||||
is mapped by other VM_LOCKED vmas.
|
||||
|
||||
We can't call try_to_munlock(), the function that walks the reverse map to check
|
||||
for other VM_LOCKED vmas, without first isolating the page from the LRU.
|
||||
try_to_munlock() is a variant of try_to_unmap() and thus requires that the page
|
||||
not be on an lru list. [More on these below.] However, the call to
|
||||
isolate_lru_page() could fail, in which case we couldn't try_to_munlock().
|
||||
So, we go ahead and clear PG_mlocked up front, as this might be the only chance
|
||||
we have. If we can successfully isolate the page, we go ahead and
|
||||
try_to_munlock(), which will restore the PG_mlocked flag and update the zone
|
||||
page statistics if it finds another vma holding the page mlocked. If we fail
|
||||
to isolate the page, we'll have left a potentially mlocked page on the LRU.
|
||||
This is fine, because we'll catch it later when/if vmscan tries to reclaim the
|
||||
page. This should be relatively rare.
|
||||
|
||||
Mlocked Pages: Migrating Them...
|
||||
|
||||
A page that is being migrated has been isolated from the lru lists and is
|
||||
held locked across unmapping of the page, updating the page's mapping
|
||||
[address_space] entry and copying the contents and state, until the
|
||||
page table entry has been replaced with an entry that refers to the new
|
||||
page. Linux supports migration of mlocked pages and other unevictable
|
||||
pages. This involves simply moving the PageMlocked and PageUnevictable states
|
||||
from the old page to the new page.
|
||||
|
||||
Note that page migration can race with mlocking or munlocking of the same
|
||||
page. This has been discussed from the mlock/munlock perspective in the
|
||||
respective sections above. Both processes [migration, m[un]locking], hold
|
||||
the page locked. This provides the first level of synchronization. Page
|
||||
migration zeros out the page_mapping of the old page before unlocking it,
|
||||
so m[un]lock can skip these pages by testing the page mapping under page
|
||||
lock.
|
||||
|
||||
When completing page migration, we place the new and old pages back onto the
|
||||
lru after dropping the page lock. The "unneeded" page--old page on success,
|
||||
new page on failure--will be freed when the reference count held by the
|
||||
migration process is released. To ensure that we don't strand pages on the
|
||||
unevictable list because of a race between munlock and migration, page
|
||||
migration uses the putback_lru_page() function to add migrated pages back to
|
||||
the lru.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Mlocked Pages: mmap(MAP_LOCKED) System Call Handling
|
||||
|
||||
In addition the the mlock()/mlockall() system calls, an application can request
|
||||
that a region of memory be mlocked using the MAP_LOCKED flag with the mmap()
|
||||
call. Furthermore, any mmap() call or brk() call that expands the heap by a
|
||||
task that has previously called mlockall() with the MCL_FUTURE flag will result
|
||||
in the newly mapped memory being mlocked. Before the unevictable/mlock changes,
|
||||
the kernel simply called make_pages_present() to allocate pages and populate
|
||||
the page table.
|
||||
|
||||
To mlock a range of memory under the unevictable/mlock infrastructure, the
|
||||
mmap() handler and task address space expansion functions call
|
||||
mlock_vma_pages_range() specifying the vma and the address range to mlock.
|
||||
mlock_vma_pages_range() filters vmas like mlock_fixup(), as described above in
|
||||
"Mlocked Pages: Filtering Vmas". It will clear the VM_LOCKED flag, which will
|
||||
have already been set by the caller, in filtered vmas. Thus these vma's need
|
||||
not be visited for munlock when the region is unmapped.
|
||||
|
||||
For "normal" vmas, mlock_vma_pages_range() calls __mlock_vma_pages_range() to
|
||||
fault/allocate the pages and mlock them. Again, like mlock_fixup(),
|
||||
mlock_vma_pages_range() downgrades the mmap semaphore to read mode before
|
||||
attempting to fault/allocate and mlock the pages; and "upgrades" the semaphore
|
||||
back to write mode before returning.
|
||||
|
||||
The callers of mlock_vma_pages_range() will have already added the memory
|
||||
range to be mlocked to the task's "locked_vm". To account for filtered vmas,
|
||||
mlock_vma_pages_range() returns the number of pages NOT mlocked. All of the
|
||||
callers then subtract a non-negative return value from the task's locked_vm.
|
||||
A negative return value represent an error--for example, from get_user_pages()
|
||||
attempting to fault in a vma with PROT_NONE access. In this case, we leave
|
||||
the memory range accounted as locked_vm, as the protections could be changed
|
||||
later and pages allocated into that region.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Mlocked Pages: munmap()/exit()/exec() System Call Handling
|
||||
|
||||
When unmapping an mlocked region of memory, whether by an explicit call to
|
||||
munmap() or via an internal unmap from exit() or exec() processing, we must
|
||||
munlock the pages if we're removing the last VM_LOCKED vma that maps the pages.
|
||||
Before the unevictable/mlock changes, mlocking did not mark the pages in any way,
|
||||
so unmapping them required no processing.
|
||||
|
||||
To munlock a range of memory under the unevictable/mlock infrastructure, the
|
||||
munmap() hander and task address space tear down function call
|
||||
munlock_vma_pages_all(). The name reflects the observation that one always
|
||||
specifies the entire vma range when munlock()ing during unmap of a region.
|
||||
Because of the vma filtering when mlocking() regions, only "normal" vmas that
|
||||
actually contain mlocked pages will be passed to munlock_vma_pages_all().
|
||||
|
||||
munlock_vma_pages_all() clears the VM_LOCKED vma flag and, like mlock_fixup()
|
||||
for the munlock case, calls __munlock_vma_pages_range() to walk the page table
|
||||
for the vma's memory range and munlock_vma_page() each resident page mapped by
|
||||
the vma. This effectively munlocks the page, only if this is the last
|
||||
VM_LOCKED vma that maps the page.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Mlocked Page: try_to_unmap()
|
||||
|
||||
[Note: the code changes represented by this section are really quite small
|
||||
compared to the text to describe what happening and why, and to discuss the
|
||||
implications.]
|
||||
|
||||
Pages can, of course, be mapped into multiple vmas. Some of these vmas may
|
||||
have VM_LOCKED flag set. It is possible for a page mapped into one or more
|
||||
VM_LOCKED vmas not to have the PG_mlocked flag set and therefore reside on one
|
||||
of the active or inactive LRU lists. This could happen if, for example, a
|
||||
task in the process of munlock()ing the page could not isolate the page from
|
||||
the LRU. As a result, vmscan/shrink_page_list() might encounter such a page
|
||||
as described in "Unevictable Pages and Vmscan [shrink_*_list()]". To
|
||||
handle this situation, try_to_unmap() has been enhanced to check for VM_LOCKED
|
||||
vmas while it is walking a page's reverse map.
|
||||
|
||||
try_to_unmap() is always called, by either vmscan for reclaim or for page
|
||||
migration, with the argument page locked and isolated from the LRU. BUG_ON()
|
||||
assertions enforce this requirement. Separate functions handle anonymous and
|
||||
mapped file pages, as these types of pages have different reverse map
|
||||
mechanisms.
|
||||
|
||||
try_to_unmap_anon()
|
||||
|
||||
To unmap anonymous pages, each vma in the list anchored in the anon_vma must be
|
||||
visited--at least until a VM_LOCKED vma is encountered. If the page is being
|
||||
unmapped for migration, VM_LOCKED vmas do not stop the process because mlocked
|
||||
pages are migratable. However, for reclaim, if the page is mapped into a
|
||||
VM_LOCKED vma, the scan stops. try_to_unmap() attempts to acquire the mmap
|
||||
semphore of the mm_struct to which the vma belongs in read mode. If this is
|
||||
successful, try_to_unmap() will mlock the page via mlock_vma_page()--we
|
||||
wouldn't have gotten to try_to_unmap() if the page were already mlocked--and
|
||||
will return SWAP_MLOCK, indicating that the page is unevictable. If the
|
||||
mmap semaphore cannot be acquired, we are not sure whether the page is really
|
||||
unevictable or not. In this case, try_to_unmap() will return SWAP_AGAIN.
|
||||
|
||||
try_to_unmap_file() -- linear mappings
|
||||
|
||||
Unmapping of a mapped file page works the same, except that the scan visits
|
||||
all vmas that maps the page's index/page offset in the page's mapping's
|
||||
reverse map priority search tree. It must also visit each vma in the page's
|
||||
mapping's non-linear list, if the list is non-empty. As for anonymous pages,
|
||||
on encountering a VM_LOCKED vma for a mapped file page, try_to_unmap() will
|
||||
attempt to acquire the associated mm_struct's mmap semaphore to mlock the page,
|
||||
returning SWAP_MLOCK if this is successful, and SWAP_AGAIN, if not.
|
||||
|
||||
try_to_unmap_file() -- non-linear mappings
|
||||
|
||||
If a page's mapping contains a non-empty non-linear mapping vma list, then
|
||||
try_to_un{map|lock}() must also visit each vma in that list to determine
|
||||
whether the page is mapped in a VM_LOCKED vma. Again, the scan must visit
|
||||
all vmas in the non-linear list to ensure that the pages is not/should not be
|
||||
mlocked. If a VM_LOCKED vma is found in the list, the scan could terminate.
|
||||
However, there is no easy way to determine whether the page is actually mapped
|
||||
in a given vma--either for unmapping or testing whether the VM_LOCKED vma
|
||||
actually pins the page.
|
||||
|
||||
So, try_to_unmap_file() handles non-linear mappings by scanning a certain
|
||||
number of pages--a "cluster"--in each non-linear vma associated with the page's
|
||||
mapping, for each file mapped page that vmscan tries to unmap. If this happens
|
||||
to unmap the page we're trying to unmap, try_to_unmap() will notice this on
|
||||
return--(page_mapcount(page) == 0)--and return SWAP_SUCCESS. Otherwise, it
|
||||
will return SWAP_AGAIN, causing vmscan to recirculate this page. We take
|
||||
advantage of the cluster scan in try_to_unmap_cluster() as follows:
|
||||
|
||||
For each non-linear vma, try_to_unmap_cluster() attempts to acquire the mmap
|
||||
semaphore of the associated mm_struct for read without blocking. If this
|
||||
attempt is successful and the vma is VM_LOCKED, try_to_unmap_cluster() will
|
||||
retain the mmap semaphore for the scan; otherwise it drops it here. Then,
|
||||
for each page in the cluster, if we're holding the mmap semaphore for a locked
|
||||
vma, try_to_unmap_cluster() calls mlock_vma_page() to mlock the page. This
|
||||
call is a no-op if the page is already locked, but will mlock any pages in
|
||||
the non-linear mapping that happen to be unlocked. If one of the pages so
|
||||
mlocked is the page passed in to try_to_unmap(), try_to_unmap_cluster() will
|
||||
return SWAP_MLOCK, rather than the default SWAP_AGAIN. This will allow vmscan
|
||||
to cull the page, rather than recirculating it on the inactive list. Again,
|
||||
if try_to_unmap_cluster() cannot acquire the vma's mmap sem, it returns
|
||||
SWAP_AGAIN, indicating that the page is mapped by a VM_LOCKED vma, but
|
||||
couldn't be mlocked.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Mlocked pages: try_to_munlock() Reverse Map Scan
|
||||
|
||||
TODO/FIXME: a better name might be page_mlocked()--analogous to the
|
||||
page_referenced() reverse map walker--especially if we continue to call this
|
||||
from shrink_page_list(). See related TODO/FIXME below.
|
||||
|
||||
When munlock_vma_page()--see "Mlocked Pages: munlock()/munlockall() System
|
||||
Call Handling" above--tries to munlock a page, or when shrink_page_list()
|
||||
encounters an anonymous page that is not yet in the swap cache, they need to
|
||||
determine whether or not the page is mapped by any VM_LOCKED vma, without
|
||||
actually attempting to unmap all ptes from the page. For this purpose, the
|
||||
unevictable/mlock infrastructure introduced a variant of try_to_unmap() called
|
||||
try_to_munlock().
|
||||
|
||||
try_to_munlock() calls the same functions as try_to_unmap() for anonymous and
|
||||
mapped file pages with an additional argument specifing unlock versus unmap
|
||||
processing. Again, these functions walk the respective reverse maps looking
|
||||
for VM_LOCKED vmas. When such a vma is found for anonymous pages and file
|
||||
pages mapped in linear VMAs, as in the try_to_unmap() case, the functions
|
||||
attempt to acquire the associated mmap semphore, mlock the page via
|
||||
mlock_vma_page() and return SWAP_MLOCK. This effectively undoes the
|
||||
pre-clearing of the page's PG_mlocked done by munlock_vma_page() and informs
|
||||
shrink_page_list() that the anonymous page should be culled rather than added
|
||||
to the swap cache in preparation for a try_to_unmap() that will almost
|
||||
certainly fail.
|
||||
|
||||
If try_to_unmap() is unable to acquire a VM_LOCKED vma's associated mmap
|
||||
semaphore, it will return SWAP_AGAIN. This will allow shrink_page_list()
|
||||
to recycle the page on the inactive list and hope that it has better luck
|
||||
with the page next time.
|
||||
|
||||
For file pages mapped into non-linear vmas, the try_to_munlock() logic works
|
||||
slightly differently. On encountering a VM_LOCKED non-linear vma that might
|
||||
map the page, try_to_munlock() returns SWAP_AGAIN without actually mlocking
|
||||
the page. munlock_vma_page() will just leave the page unlocked and let
|
||||
vmscan deal with it--the usual fallback position.
|
||||
|
||||
Note that try_to_munlock()'s reverse map walk must visit every vma in a pages'
|
||||
reverse map to determine that a page is NOT mapped into any VM_LOCKED vma.
|
||||
However, the scan can terminate when it encounters a VM_LOCKED vma and can
|
||||
successfully acquire the vma's mmap semphore for read and mlock the page.
|
||||
Although try_to_munlock() can be called many [very many!] times when
|
||||
munlock()ing a large region or tearing down a large address space that has been
|
||||
mlocked via mlockall(), overall this is a fairly rare event. In addition,
|
||||
although shrink_page_list() calls try_to_munlock() for every anonymous page that
|
||||
it handles that is not yet in the swap cache, on average anonymous pages will
|
||||
have very short reverse map lists.
|
||||
|
||||
Mlocked Page: Page Reclaim in shrink_*_list()
|
||||
|
||||
shrink_active_list() culls any obviously unevictable pages--i.e.,
|
||||
!page_evictable(page, NULL)--diverting these to the unevictable lru
|
||||
list. However, shrink_active_list() only sees unevictable pages that
|
||||
made it onto the active/inactive lru lists. Note that these pages do not
|
||||
have PageUnevictable set--otherwise, they would be on the unevictable list and
|
||||
shrink_active_list would never see them.
|
||||
|
||||
Some examples of these unevictable pages on the LRU lists are:
|
||||
|
||||
1) ramfs pages that have been placed on the lru lists when first allocated.
|
||||
|
||||
2) SHM_LOCKed shared memory pages. shmctl(SHM_LOCK) does not attempt to
|
||||
allocate or fault in the pages in the shared memory region. This happens
|
||||
when an application accesses the page the first time after SHM_LOCKing
|
||||
the segment.
|
||||
|
||||
3) Mlocked pages that could not be isolated from the lru and moved to the
|
||||
unevictable list in mlock_vma_page().
|
||||
|
||||
3) Pages mapped into multiple VM_LOCKED vmas, but try_to_munlock() couldn't
|
||||
acquire the vma's mmap semaphore to test the flags and set PageMlocked.
|
||||
munlock_vma_page() was forced to let the page back on to the normal
|
||||
LRU list for vmscan to handle.
|
||||
|
||||
shrink_inactive_list() also culls any unevictable pages that it finds
|
||||
on the inactive lists, again diverting them to the appropriate zone's unevictable
|
||||
lru list. shrink_inactive_list() should only see SHM_LOCKed pages that became
|
||||
SHM_LOCKed after shrink_active_list() had moved them to the inactive list, or
|
||||
pages mapped into VM_LOCKED vmas that munlock_vma_page() couldn't isolate from
|
||||
the lru to recheck via try_to_munlock(). shrink_inactive_list() won't notice
|
||||
the latter, but will pass on to shrink_page_list().
|
||||
|
||||
shrink_page_list() again culls obviously unevictable pages that it could
|
||||
encounter for similar reason to shrink_inactive_list(). As already discussed,
|
||||
shrink_page_list() proactively looks for anonymous pages that should have
|
||||
PG_mlocked set but don't--these would not be detected by page_evictable()--to
|
||||
avoid adding them to the swap cache unnecessarily. File pages mapped into
|
||||
VM_LOCKED vmas but without PG_mlocked set will make it all the way to
|
||||
try_to_unmap(). shrink_page_list() will divert them to the unevictable list when
|
||||
try_to_unmap() returns SWAP_MLOCK, as discussed above.
|
||||
|
||||
TODO/FIXME: If we can enhance the swap cache to reliably remove entries
|
||||
with page_count(page) > 2, as long as all ptes are mapped to the page and
|
||||
not the swap entry, we can probably remove the call to try_to_munlock() in
|
||||
shrink_page_list() and just remove the page from the swap cache when
|
||||
try_to_unmap() returns SWAP_MLOCK. Currently, remove_exclusive_swap_page()
|
||||
doesn't seem to allow that.
|
||||
|
||||
|
64
MAINTAINERS
64
MAINTAINERS
|
@ -378,8 +378,9 @@ T: git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/joro/linux-2.6-iommu.git
|
|||
S: Supported
|
||||
|
||||
AMD MICROCODE UPDATE SUPPORT
|
||||
P: Peter Oruba
|
||||
M: peter.oruba@amd.com
|
||||
P: Andreas Herrmann
|
||||
M: andeas.herrmann3@amd.com
|
||||
L: amd64-microcode@amd64.org
|
||||
S: Supported
|
||||
|
||||
AMS (Apple Motion Sensor) DRIVER
|
||||
|
@ -1053,6 +1054,12 @@ L: cbe-oss-dev@ozlabs.org
|
|||
W: http://www.ibm.com/developerworks/power/cell/
|
||||
S: Supported
|
||||
|
||||
CERTIFIED WIRELESS USB (WUSB) SUBSYSTEM:
|
||||
P: David Vrabel
|
||||
M: david.vrabel@csr.com
|
||||
L: linux-usb@vger.kernel.org
|
||||
S: Supported
|
||||
|
||||
CFAG12864B LCD DRIVER
|
||||
P: Miguel Ojeda Sandonis
|
||||
M: miguel.ojeda.sandonis@gmail.com
|
||||
|
@ -1198,7 +1205,7 @@ S: Maintained
|
|||
|
||||
CPU FREQUENCY DRIVERS
|
||||
P: Dave Jones
|
||||
M: davej@codemonkey.org.uk
|
||||
M: davej@redhat.com
|
||||
L: cpufreq@vger.kernel.org
|
||||
W: http://www.codemonkey.org.uk/projects/cpufreq/
|
||||
T: git kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/davej/cpufreq.git
|
||||
|
@ -1427,8 +1434,8 @@ M: rdunlap@xenotime.net
|
|||
S: Maintained
|
||||
|
||||
DOCKING STATION DRIVER
|
||||
P: Kristen Carlson Accardi
|
||||
M: kristen.c.accardi@intel.com
|
||||
P: Shaohua Li
|
||||
M: shaohua.li@intel.com
|
||||
L: linux-acpi@vger.kernel.org
|
||||
S: Supported
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -2103,6 +2110,12 @@ L: linux-ide@vger.kernel.org
|
|||
L: linux-scsi@vger.kernel.org
|
||||
S: Orphan
|
||||
|
||||
IDLE-I7300
|
||||
P: Andy Henroid
|
||||
M: andrew.d.henroid@intel.com
|
||||
L: linux-pm@lists.linux-foundation.org
|
||||
S: Supported
|
||||
|
||||
IEEE 1394 SUBSYSTEM (drivers/ieee1394)
|
||||
P: Ben Collins
|
||||
M: ben.collins@ubuntu.com
|
||||
|
@ -2176,6 +2189,13 @@ M: maciej.sosnowski@intel.com
|
|||
L: linux-kernel@vger.kernel.org
|
||||
S: Supported
|
||||
|
||||
INTEL IOMMU (VT-d)
|
||||
P: David Woodhouse
|
||||
M: dwmw2@infradead.org
|
||||
L: iommu@lists.linux-foundation.org
|
||||
T: git://git.infradead.org/iommu-2.6.git
|
||||
S: Supported
|
||||
|
||||
INTEL IOP-ADMA DMA DRIVER
|
||||
P: Dan Williams
|
||||
M: dan.j.williams@intel.com
|
||||
|
@ -2928,9 +2948,9 @@ S: Maintained
|
|||
|
||||
NETEFFECT IWARP RNIC DRIVER (IW_NES)
|
||||
P: Faisal Latif
|
||||
M: flatif@neteffect.com
|
||||
M: faisal.latif@intel.com
|
||||
P: Chien Tung
|
||||
M: ctung@neteffect.com
|
||||
M: chien.tin.tung@intel.com
|
||||
L: general@lists.openfabrics.org
|
||||
W: http://www.neteffect.com
|
||||
S: Supported
|
||||
|
@ -3173,6 +3193,11 @@ M: olof@lixom.net
|
|||
L: i2c@lm-sensors.org
|
||||
S: Maintained
|
||||
|
||||
PANASONIC LAPTOP ACPI EXTRAS DRIVER
|
||||
P: Harald Welte
|
||||
M: laforge@gnumonks.org
|
||||
S: Maintained
|
||||
|
||||
PANASONIC MN10300/AM33 PORT
|
||||
P: David Howells
|
||||
M: dhowells@redhat.com
|
||||
|
@ -3244,11 +3269,6 @@ L: linux-pci@vger.kernel.org
|
|||
T: git kernel.org:/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/jbarnes/pci-2.6.git
|
||||
S: Supported
|
||||
|
||||
PCI HOTPLUG CORE
|
||||
P: Kristen Carlson Accardi
|
||||
M: kristen.c.accardi@intel.com
|
||||
S: Supported
|
||||
|
||||
PCIE HOTPLUG DRIVER
|
||||
P: Kristen Carlson Accardi
|
||||
M: kristen.c.accardi@intel.com
|
||||
|
@ -3937,7 +3957,7 @@ M: jbglaw@lug-owl.de
|
|||
L: linux-kernel@vger.kernel.org
|
||||
S: Maintained
|
||||
|
||||
STABLE BRANCH:
|
||||
STABLE BRANCH
|
||||
P: Greg Kroah-Hartman
|
||||
M: greg@kroah.com
|
||||
P: Chris Wright
|
||||
|
@ -3945,6 +3965,13 @@ M: chrisw@sous-sol.org
|
|||
L: stable@kernel.org
|
||||
S: Maintained
|
||||
|
||||
STAGING SUBSYSTEM
|
||||
P: Greg Kroah-Hartman
|
||||
M: gregkh@suse.de
|
||||
L: linux-kernel@vger.kernel.org
|
||||
T: quilt kernel.org/pub/linux/kernel/people/gregkh/gregkh-2.6/
|
||||
S: Maintained
|
||||
|
||||
STARFIRE/DURALAN NETWORK DRIVER
|
||||
P: Ion Badulescu
|
||||
M: ionut@cs.columbia.edu
|
||||
|
@ -4184,6 +4211,12 @@ L: sparclinux@vger.kernel.org
|
|||
T: git kernel.org:/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git/davem/sparc-2.6.git
|
||||
S: Maintained
|
||||
|
||||
ULTRA-WIDEBAND (UWB) SUBSYSTEM:
|
||||
P: David Vrabel
|
||||
M: david.vrabel@csr.com
|
||||
L: linux-usb@vger.kernel.org
|
||||
S: Supported
|
||||
|
||||
UNIFORM CDROM DRIVER
|
||||
P: Jens Axboe
|
||||
M: axboe@kernel.dk
|
||||
|
@ -4609,6 +4642,11 @@ M: zaga@fly.cc.fer.hr
|
|||
L: linux-scsi@vger.kernel.org
|
||||
S: Maintained
|
||||
|
||||
WIMEDIA LLC PROTOCOL (WLP) SUBSYSTEM
|
||||
P: David Vrabel
|
||||
M: david.vrabel@csr.com
|
||||
S: Maintained
|
||||
|
||||
WISTRON LAPTOP BUTTON DRIVER
|
||||
P: Miloslav Trmac
|
||||
M: mitr@volny.cz
|
||||
|
|
8
Makefile
8
Makefile
|
@ -1,8 +1,8 @@
|
|||
VERSION = 2
|
||||
PATCHLEVEL = 6
|
||||
SUBLEVEL = 27
|
||||
EXTRAVERSION =
|
||||
NAME = Rotary Wombat
|
||||
SUBLEVEL = 28
|
||||
EXTRAVERSION = -rc1
|
||||
NAME = Killer Bat of Doom
|
||||
|
||||
# *DOCUMENTATION*
|
||||
# To see a list of typical targets execute "make help"
|
||||
|
@ -437,7 +437,7 @@ ifeq ($(config-targets),1)
|
|||
# KBUILD_DEFCONFIG may point out an alternative default configuration
|
||||
# used for 'make defconfig'
|
||||
include $(srctree)/arch/$(SRCARCH)/Makefile
|
||||
export KBUILD_DEFCONFIG
|
||||
export KBUILD_DEFCONFIG KBUILD_KCONFIG
|
||||
|
||||
config %config: scripts_basic outputmakefile FORCE
|
||||
$(Q)mkdir -p include/linux include/config
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -70,6 +70,7 @@ config AUTO_IRQ_AFFINITY
|
|||
default y
|
||||
|
||||
source "init/Kconfig"
|
||||
source "kernel/Kconfig.freezer"
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
menu "System setup"
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -74,12 +74,14 @@ register struct thread_info *__current_thread_info __asm__("$8");
|
|||
#define TIF_UAC_SIGBUS 7
|
||||
#define TIF_MEMDIE 8
|
||||
#define TIF_RESTORE_SIGMASK 9 /* restore signal mask in do_signal */
|
||||
#define TIF_FREEZE 16 /* is freezing for suspend */
|
||||
|
||||
#define _TIF_SYSCALL_TRACE (1<<TIF_SYSCALL_TRACE)
|
||||
#define _TIF_SIGPENDING (1<<TIF_SIGPENDING)
|
||||
#define _TIF_NEED_RESCHED (1<<TIF_NEED_RESCHED)
|
||||
#define _TIF_POLLING_NRFLAG (1<<TIF_POLLING_NRFLAG)
|
||||
#define _TIF_RESTORE_SIGMASK (1<<TIF_RESTORE_SIGMASK)
|
||||
#define _TIF_FREEZE (1<<TIF_FREEZE)
|
||||
|
||||
/* Work to do on interrupt/exception return. */
|
||||
#define _TIF_WORK_MASK (_TIF_SIGPENDING | _TIF_NEED_RESCHED)
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -655,7 +655,7 @@ __marvel_rtc_io(u8 b, unsigned long addr, int write)
|
|||
|
||||
case 0x71: /* RTC_PORT(1) */
|
||||
rtc_access.index = index;
|
||||
rtc_access.data = BCD_TO_BIN(b);
|
||||
rtc_access.data = bcd2bin(b);
|
||||
rtc_access.function = 0x48 + !write; /* GET/PUT_TOY */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef CONFIG_SMP
|
||||
|
@ -668,7 +668,7 @@ __marvel_rtc_io(u8 b, unsigned long addr, int write)
|
|||
#else
|
||||
__marvel_access_rtc(&rtc_access);
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
ret = BIN_TO_BCD(rtc_access.data);
|
||||
ret = bin2bcd(rtc_access.data);
|
||||
break;
|
||||
|
||||
default:
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -165,14 +165,11 @@ osf_getdirentries(unsigned int fd, struct osf_dirent __user *dirent,
|
|||
buf.error = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
error = vfs_readdir(file, osf_filldir, &buf);
|
||||
if (error < 0)
|
||||
goto out_putf;
|
||||
|
||||
error = buf.error;
|
||||
if (error >= 0)
|
||||
error = buf.error;
|
||||
if (count != buf.count)
|
||||
error = count - buf.count;
|
||||
|
||||
out_putf:
|
||||
fput(file);
|
||||
out:
|
||||
return error;
|
||||
|
@ -986,10 +983,12 @@ asmlinkage int
|
|||
osf_select(int n, fd_set __user *inp, fd_set __user *outp, fd_set __user *exp,
|
||||
struct timeval32 __user *tvp)
|
||||
{
|
||||
s64 timeout = MAX_SCHEDULE_TIMEOUT;
|
||||
struct timespec end_time, *to = NULL;
|
||||
if (tvp) {
|
||||
time_t sec, usec;
|
||||
|
||||
to = &end_time;
|
||||
|
||||
if (!access_ok(VERIFY_READ, tvp, sizeof(*tvp))
|
||||
|| __get_user(sec, &tvp->tv_sec)
|
||||
|| __get_user(usec, &tvp->tv_usec)) {
|
||||
|
@ -999,14 +998,13 @@ osf_select(int n, fd_set __user *inp, fd_set __user *outp, fd_set __user *exp,
|
|||
if (sec < 0 || usec < 0)
|
||||
return -EINVAL;
|
||||
|
||||
if ((unsigned long) sec < MAX_SELECT_SECONDS) {
|
||||
timeout = (usec + 1000000/HZ - 1) / (1000000/HZ);
|
||||
timeout += sec * (unsigned long) HZ;
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (poll_select_set_timeout(to, sec, usec * NSEC_PER_USEC))
|
||||
return -EINVAL;
|
||||
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* OSF does not copy back the remaining time. */
|
||||
return core_sys_select(n, inp, outp, exp, &timeout);
|
||||
return core_sys_select(n, inp, outp, exp, to);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
struct rusage32 {
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -47,7 +47,7 @@ typedef struct irq_swizzle_struct
|
|||
|
||||
static irq_swizzle_t *sable_lynx_irq_swizzle;
|
||||
|
||||
static void sable_lynx_init_irq(int nr_irqs);
|
||||
static void sable_lynx_init_irq(int nr_of_irqs);
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined(CONFIG_ALPHA_GENERIC) || defined(CONFIG_ALPHA_SABLE)
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -530,11 +530,11 @@ sable_lynx_srm_device_interrupt(unsigned long vector)
|
|||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static void __init
|
||||
sable_lynx_init_irq(int nr_irqs)
|
||||
sable_lynx_init_irq(int nr_of_irqs)
|
||||
{
|
||||
long i;
|
||||
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < nr_irqs; ++i) {
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < nr_of_irqs; ++i) {
|
||||
irq_desc[i].status = IRQ_DISABLED | IRQ_LEVEL;
|
||||
irq_desc[i].chip = &sable_lynx_irq_type;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -346,12 +346,12 @@ time_init(void)
|
|||
year = CMOS_READ(RTC_YEAR);
|
||||
|
||||
if (!(CMOS_READ(RTC_CONTROL) & RTC_DM_BINARY) || RTC_ALWAYS_BCD) {
|
||||
BCD_TO_BIN(sec);
|
||||
BCD_TO_BIN(min);
|
||||
BCD_TO_BIN(hour);
|
||||
BCD_TO_BIN(day);
|
||||
BCD_TO_BIN(mon);
|
||||
BCD_TO_BIN(year);
|
||||
sec = bcd2bin(sec);
|
||||
min = bcd2bin(min);
|
||||
hour = bcd2bin(hour);
|
||||
day = bcd2bin(day);
|
||||
mon = bcd2bin(mon);
|
||||
year = bcd2bin(year);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* PC-like is standard; used for year >= 70 */
|
||||
|
@ -525,7 +525,7 @@ set_rtc_mmss(unsigned long nowtime)
|
|||
|
||||
cmos_minutes = CMOS_READ(RTC_MINUTES);
|
||||
if (!(save_control & RTC_DM_BINARY) || RTC_ALWAYS_BCD)
|
||||
BCD_TO_BIN(cmos_minutes);
|
||||
cmos_minutes = bcd2bin(cmos_minutes);
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* since we're only adjusting minutes and seconds,
|
||||
|
@ -543,8 +543,8 @@ set_rtc_mmss(unsigned long nowtime)
|
|||
|
||||
if (abs(real_minutes - cmos_minutes) < 30) {
|
||||
if (!(save_control & RTC_DM_BINARY) || RTC_ALWAYS_BCD) {
|
||||
BIN_TO_BCD(real_seconds);
|
||||
BIN_TO_BCD(real_minutes);
|
||||
real_seconds = bin2bcd(real_seconds);
|
||||
real_minutes = bin2bcd(real_minutes);
|
||||
}
|
||||
CMOS_WRITE(real_seconds,RTC_SECONDS);
|
||||
CMOS_WRITE(real_minutes,RTC_MINUTES);
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -106,7 +106,7 @@ op_axp_stop(void)
|
|||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static int
|
||||
op_axp_create_files(struct super_block * sb, struct dentry * root)
|
||||
op_axp_create_files(struct super_block *sb, struct dentry *root)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int i;
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -192,6 +192,8 @@ config VECTORS_BASE
|
|||
|
||||
source "init/Kconfig"
|
||||
|
||||
source "kernel/Kconfig.freezer"
|
||||
|
||||
menu "System Type"
|
||||
|
||||
choice
|
||||
|
@ -354,7 +356,7 @@ config ARCH_IXP4XX
|
|||
select GENERIC_GPIO
|
||||
select GENERIC_TIME
|
||||
select GENERIC_CLOCKEVENTS
|
||||
select ZONE_DMA if PCI
|
||||
select DMABOUNCE if PCI
|
||||
help
|
||||
Support for Intel's IXP4XX (XScale) family of processors.
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -538,16 +540,15 @@ config ARCH_OMAP
|
|||
help
|
||||
Support for TI's OMAP platform (OMAP1 and OMAP2).
|
||||
|
||||
config ARCH_MSM7X00A
|
||||
bool "Qualcomm MSM7X00A"
|
||||
config ARCH_MSM
|
||||
bool "Qualcomm MSM"
|
||||
select GENERIC_TIME
|
||||
select GENERIC_CLOCKEVENTS
|
||||
help
|
||||
Support for Qualcomm MSM7X00A based systems. This runs on the ARM11
|
||||
apps processor of the MSM7X00A and depends on a shared memory
|
||||
Support for Qualcomm MSM7K based systems. This runs on the ARM11
|
||||
apps processor of the MSM7K and depends on a shared memory
|
||||
interface to the ARM9 modem processor which runs the baseband stack
|
||||
and controls some vital subsystems (clock and power control, etc).
|
||||
<http://www.cdmatech.com/products/msm7200_chipset_solution.jsp>
|
||||
|
||||
endchoice
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -1254,6 +1255,8 @@ source "drivers/hid/Kconfig"
|
|||
|
||||
source "drivers/usb/Kconfig"
|
||||
|
||||
source "drivers/uwb/Kconfig"
|
||||
|
||||
source "drivers/mmc/Kconfig"
|
||||
|
||||
source "drivers/memstick/Kconfig"
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -141,7 +141,7 @@ endif
|
|||
machine-$(CONFIG_ARCH_MX3) := mx3
|
||||
machine-$(CONFIG_ARCH_ORION5X) := orion5x
|
||||
plat-$(CONFIG_PLAT_ORION) := orion
|
||||
machine-$(CONFIG_ARCH_MSM7X00A) := msm
|
||||
machine-$(CONFIG_ARCH_MSM) := msm
|
||||
machine-$(CONFIG_ARCH_LOKI) := loki
|
||||
machine-$(CONFIG_ARCH_MV78XX0) := mv78xx0
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -13,10 +13,10 @@ config ICST307
|
|||
config SA1111
|
||||
bool
|
||||
select DMABOUNCE if !ARCH_PXA
|
||||
select ZONE_DMA if !ARCH_PXA
|
||||
|
||||
config DMABOUNCE
|
||||
bool
|
||||
select ZONE_DMA
|
||||
|
||||
config TIMER_ACORN
|
||||
bool
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -581,6 +581,7 @@ sa1111_init_one_child(struct sa1111 *sachip, struct resource *parent,
|
|||
goto out;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef CONFIG_DMABOUNCE
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* If the parent device has a DMA mask associated with it,
|
||||
* propagate it down to the children.
|
||||
|
@ -598,6 +599,7 @@ sa1111_init_one_child(struct sa1111 *sachip, struct resource *parent,
|
|||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
out:
|
||||
return ret;
|
||||
|
@ -937,7 +939,7 @@ static int sa1111_resume(struct platform_device *dev)
|
|||
#define sa1111_resume NULL
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
static int sa1111_probe(struct platform_device *pdev)
|
||||
static int __devinit sa1111_probe(struct platform_device *pdev)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct resource *mem;
|
||||
int irq;
|
||||
|
|
File diff suppressed because it is too large
Load Diff
|
@ -133,7 +133,7 @@ CONFIG_DEFAULT_IOSCHED="anticipatory"
|
|||
# CONFIG_ARCH_LH7A40X is not set
|
||||
# CONFIG_ARCH_DAVINCI is not set
|
||||
# CONFIG_ARCH_OMAP is not set
|
||||
CONFIG_ARCH_MSM7X00A=y
|
||||
CONFIG_ARCH_MSM=y
|
||||
|
||||
#
|
||||
# Boot options
|
||||
|
|
File diff suppressed because it is too large
Load Diff
|
@ -147,6 +147,7 @@ CONFIG_ARCH_PXA=y
|
|||
# CONFIG_MACH_MAINSTONE is not set
|
||||
# CONFIG_ARCH_PXA_IDP is not set
|
||||
# CONFIG_PXA_SHARPSL is not set
|
||||
CONFIG_TRIZEPS_PXA=y
|
||||
CONFIG_MACH_TRIZEPS4=y
|
||||
CONFIG_MACH_TRIZEPS4_CONXS=y
|
||||
# CONFIG_MACH_TRIZEPS4_ANY is not set
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -165,7 +165,7 @@
|
|||
__res = __m; \
|
||||
asm ( "umlal %Q0, %R0, %Q1, %Q2\n\t" \
|
||||
"mov %Q0, #0" \
|
||||
: "+r" (__res) \
|
||||
: "+&r" (__res) \
|
||||
: "r" (__m), "r" (__n) \
|
||||
: "cc" ); \
|
||||
} else { \
|
||||
|
@ -182,7 +182,7 @@
|
|||
"umlal %R0, %Q0, %Q1, %R2\n\t" \
|
||||
"mov %R0, #0\n\t" \
|
||||
"umlal %Q0, %R0, %R1, %R2" \
|
||||
: "+r" (__res) \
|
||||
: "+&r" (__res) \
|
||||
: "r" (__m), "r" (__n) \
|
||||
: "cc" ); \
|
||||
} else { \
|
||||
|
@ -192,7 +192,7 @@
|
|||
"adds %Q0, %1, %Q0\n\t" \
|
||||
"adc %R0, %R0, #0\n\t" \
|
||||
"umlal %Q0, %R0, %R2, %R3" \
|
||||
: "+r" (__res), "+r" (__z) \
|
||||
: "+&r" (__res), "+&r" (__z) \
|
||||
: "r" (__m), "r" (__n) \
|
||||
: "cc" ); \
|
||||
} \
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -404,6 +404,7 @@ static void gpio_irq_handler(unsigned irq, struct irq_desc *desc)
|
|||
}
|
||||
|
||||
pin = bank->chipbase;
|
||||
gpio = &irq_desc[pin];
|
||||
|
||||
while (isr) {
|
||||
if (isr & 1) {
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -89,6 +89,8 @@
|
|||
* node 3: 0xd8000000 - 0xdfffffff
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define NODE_MEM_SIZE_BITS 24
|
||||
#define SECTION_SIZE_BITS 24
|
||||
#define MAX_PHYSMEM_BITS 32
|
||||
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -41,7 +41,7 @@ static inline unsigned long iop13xx_core_freq(void)
|
|||
return 1200000000;
|
||||
default:
|
||||
printk("%s: warning unknown frequency, defaulting to 800Mhz\n",
|
||||
__FUNCTION__);
|
||||
__func__);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return 800000000;
|
||||
|
@ -60,7 +60,7 @@ static inline unsigned long iop13xx_xsi_bus_ratio(void)
|
|||
return 4;
|
||||
default:
|
||||
printk("%s: warning unknown ratio, defaulting to 2\n",
|
||||
__FUNCTION__);
|
||||
__func__);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
return 2;
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -143,7 +143,7 @@ static struct irq_chip ixdp2x00_cpld_irq_chip = {
|
|||
.unmask = ixdp2x00_irq_unmask
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
void __init ixdp2x00_init_irq(volatile unsigned long *stat_reg, volatile unsigned long *mask_reg, unsigned long nr_irqs)
|
||||
void __init ixdp2x00_init_irq(volatile unsigned long *stat_reg, volatile unsigned long *mask_reg, unsigned long nr_of_irqs)
|
||||
{
|
||||
unsigned int irq;
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -154,7 +154,7 @@ void __init ixdp2x00_init_irq(volatile unsigned long *stat_reg, volatile unsigne
|
|||
|
||||
board_irq_stat = stat_reg;
|
||||
board_irq_mask = mask_reg;
|
||||
board_irq_count = nr_irqs;
|
||||
board_irq_count = nr_of_irqs;
|
||||
|
||||
*board_irq_mask = 0xffffffff;
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -167,11 +167,6 @@ config MACH_GTWX5715
|
|||
|
||||
comment "IXP4xx Options"
|
||||
|
||||
config DMABOUNCE
|
||||
bool
|
||||
default y
|
||||
depends on PCI
|
||||
|
||||
config IXP4XX_INDIRECT_PCI
|
||||
bool "Use indirect PCI memory access"
|
||||
depends on PCI
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -2,4 +2,4 @@ obj-y += common.o addr-map.o irq.o pcie.o
|
|||
|
||||
obj-$(CONFIG_MACH_DB88F6281_BP) += db88f6281-bp-setup.o
|
||||
obj-$(CONFIG_MACH_RD88F6192_NAS) += rd88f6192-nas-setup.o
|
||||
obj-$(CONFIG_MACH_RD88F6192_NAS) += rd88f6281-setup.o
|
||||
obj-$(CONFIG_MACH_RD88F6281) += rd88f6281-setup.o
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -16,6 +16,7 @@
|
|||
#include <linux/mv643xx_eth.h>
|
||||
#include <linux/ata_platform.h>
|
||||
#include <linux/spi/orion_spi.h>
|
||||
#include <net/dsa.h>
|
||||
#include <asm/page.h>
|
||||
#include <asm/timex.h>
|
||||
#include <asm/mach/map.h>
|
||||
|
@ -151,6 +152,40 @@ void __init kirkwood_ge00_init(struct mv643xx_eth_platform_data *eth_data)
|
|||
}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*****************************************************************************
|
||||
* Ethernet switch
|
||||
****************************************************************************/
|
||||
static struct resource kirkwood_switch_resources[] = {
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = 0,
|
||||
.end = 0,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_IRQ,
|
||||
},
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static struct platform_device kirkwood_switch_device = {
|
||||
.name = "dsa",
|
||||
.id = 0,
|
||||
.num_resources = 0,
|
||||
.resource = kirkwood_switch_resources,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
void __init kirkwood_ge00_switch_init(struct dsa_platform_data *d, int irq)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (irq != NO_IRQ) {
|
||||
kirkwood_switch_resources[0].start = irq;
|
||||
kirkwood_switch_resources[0].end = irq;
|
||||
kirkwood_switch_device.num_resources = 1;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
d->mii_bus = &kirkwood_ge00_shared.dev;
|
||||
d->netdev = &kirkwood_ge00.dev;
|
||||
kirkwood_switch_device.dev.platform_data = d;
|
||||
|
||||
platform_device_register(&kirkwood_switch_device);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*****************************************************************************
|
||||
* SoC RTC
|
||||
****************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -11,6 +11,7 @@
|
|||
#ifndef __ARCH_KIRKWOOD_COMMON_H
|
||||
#define __ARCH_KIRKWOOD_COMMON_H
|
||||
|
||||
struct dsa_platform_data;
|
||||
struct mv643xx_eth_platform_data;
|
||||
struct mv_sata_platform_data;
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -29,6 +30,7 @@ void kirkwood_pcie_id(u32 *dev, u32 *rev);
|
|||
|
||||
void kirkwood_ehci_init(void);
|
||||
void kirkwood_ge00_init(struct mv643xx_eth_platform_data *eth_data);
|
||||
void kirkwood_ge00_switch_init(struct dsa_platform_data *d, int irq);
|
||||
void kirkwood_pcie_init(void);
|
||||
void kirkwood_rtc_init(void);
|
||||
void kirkwood_sata_init(struct mv_sata_platform_data *sata_data);
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -19,6 +19,7 @@
|
|||
#include <linux/ata_platform.h>
|
||||
#include <linux/mv643xx_eth.h>
|
||||
#include <linux/ethtool.h>
|
||||
#include <net/dsa.h>
|
||||
#include <asm/mach-types.h>
|
||||
#include <asm/mach/arch.h>
|
||||
#include <asm/mach/pci.h>
|
||||
|
@ -74,6 +75,15 @@ static struct mv643xx_eth_platform_data rd88f6281_ge00_data = {
|
|||
.duplex = DUPLEX_FULL,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static struct dsa_platform_data rd88f6281_switch_data = {
|
||||
.port_names[0] = "lan1",
|
||||
.port_names[1] = "lan2",
|
||||
.port_names[2] = "lan3",
|
||||
.port_names[3] = "lan4",
|
||||
.port_names[4] = "wan",
|
||||
.port_names[5] = "cpu",
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static struct mv_sata_platform_data rd88f6281_sata_data = {
|
||||
.n_ports = 2,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
@ -87,6 +97,7 @@ static void __init rd88f6281_init(void)
|
|||
|
||||
kirkwood_ehci_init();
|
||||
kirkwood_ge00_init(&rd88f6281_ge00_data);
|
||||
kirkwood_ge00_switch_init(&rd88f6281_switch_data, NO_IRQ);
|
||||
kirkwood_rtc_init();
|
||||
kirkwood_sata_init(&rd88f6281_sata_data);
|
||||
kirkwood_uart0_init();
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -1,18 +1,13 @@
|
|||
if ARCH_MSM7X00A
|
||||
if ARCH_MSM
|
||||
|
||||
comment "MSM7X00A Board Type"
|
||||
depends on ARCH_MSM7X00A
|
||||
comment "MSM Board Type"
|
||||
depends on ARCH_MSM
|
||||
|
||||
config MACH_HALIBUT
|
||||
depends on ARCH_MSM7X00A
|
||||
depends on ARCH_MSM
|
||||
default y
|
||||
bool "Halibut Board (QCT SURF7200A)"
|
||||
bool "Halibut Board (QCT SURF7201A)"
|
||||
help
|
||||
Support for the Qualcomm SURF7200A eval board.
|
||||
|
||||
config MSM7X00A_IDLE
|
||||
depends on ARCH_MSM7X00A
|
||||
default y
|
||||
bool "Idle Support for MSM7X00A"
|
||||
Support for the Qualcomm SURF7201A eval board.
|
||||
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -1,7 +1,8 @@
|
|||
obj-y += io.o idle.o irq.o timer.o dma.o
|
||||
|
||||
# Common code for board init
|
||||
obj-y += common.o
|
||||
obj-y += devices.o
|
||||
obj-y += proc_comm.o
|
||||
obj-y += vreg.o
|
||||
obj-y += clock.o clock-7x01a.o
|
||||
|
||||
obj-$(CONFIG_MACH_HALIBUT) += board-halibut.o
|
||||
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -33,6 +33,8 @@
|
|||
#include <linux/mtd/nand.h>
|
||||
#include <linux/mtd/partitions.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "devices.h"
|
||||
|
||||
static struct resource smc91x_resources[] = {
|
||||
[0] = {
|
||||
.start = 0x9C004300,
|
||||
|
@ -53,31 +55,12 @@ static struct platform_device smc91x_device = {
|
|||
.resource = smc91x_resources,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static void mddi0_panel_power(int on)
|
||||
{
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static struct msm_mddi_platform_data msm_mddi0_pdata = {
|
||||
.panel_power = mddi0_panel_power,
|
||||
.has_vsync_irq = 0,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static struct platform_device msm_mddi0_device = {
|
||||
.name = "msm_mddi",
|
||||
.id = 0,
|
||||
.dev = {
|
||||
.platform_data = &msm_mddi0_pdata
|
||||
},
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static struct platform_device msm_serial0_device = {
|
||||
.name = "msm_serial",
|
||||
.id = 0,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static struct platform_device *devices[] __initdata = {
|
||||
&msm_serial0_device,
|
||||
&msm_mddi0_device,
|
||||
&msm_device_uart3,
|
||||
&msm_device_smd,
|
||||
&msm_device_nand,
|
||||
&msm_device_hsusb,
|
||||
&msm_device_i2c,
|
||||
&smc91x_device,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -91,20 +74,15 @@ static void __init halibut_init_irq(void)
|
|||
static void __init halibut_init(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
platform_add_devices(devices, ARRAY_SIZE(devices));
|
||||
msm_add_devices();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static void __init halibut_map_io(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
msm_map_common_io();
|
||||
msm_clock_init();
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
MACHINE_START(HALIBUT, "Halibut Board (QCT SURF7200A)")
|
||||
|
||||
/* UART for LL DEBUG */
|
||||
.phys_io = MSM_UART1_PHYS,
|
||||
.io_pg_offst = ((MSM_UART1_BASE) >> 18) & 0xfffc,
|
||||
|
||||
.boot_params = 0x10000100,
|
||||
.map_io = halibut_map_io,
|
||||
.init_irq = halibut_init_irq,
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,126 @@
|
|||
/* arch/arm/mach-msm/clock-7x01a.c
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Clock tables for MSM7X01A
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Copyright (C) 2007 Google, Inc.
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2007 QUALCOMM Incorporated
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This software is licensed under the terms of the GNU General Public
|
||||
* License version 2, as published by the Free Software Foundation, and
|
||||
* may be copied, distributed, and modified under those terms.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
* GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include <linux/kernel.h>
|
||||
#include <linux/platform_device.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "clock.h"
|
||||
#include "devices.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/* clock IDs used by the modem processor */
|
||||
|
||||
#define ACPU_CLK 0 /* Applications processor clock */
|
||||
#define ADM_CLK 1 /* Applications data mover clock */
|
||||
#define ADSP_CLK 2 /* ADSP clock */
|
||||
#define EBI1_CLK 3 /* External bus interface 1 clock */
|
||||
#define EBI2_CLK 4 /* External bus interface 2 clock */
|
||||
#define ECODEC_CLK 5 /* External CODEC clock */
|
||||
#define EMDH_CLK 6 /* External MDDI host clock */
|
||||
#define GP_CLK 7 /* General purpose clock */
|
||||
#define GRP_CLK 8 /* Graphics clock */
|
||||
#define I2C_CLK 9 /* I2C clock */
|
||||
#define ICODEC_RX_CLK 10 /* Internal CODEX RX clock */
|
||||
#define ICODEC_TX_CLK 11 /* Internal CODEX TX clock */
|
||||
#define IMEM_CLK 12 /* Internal graphics memory clock */
|
||||
#define MDC_CLK 13 /* MDDI client clock */
|
||||
#define MDP_CLK 14 /* Mobile display processor clock */
|
||||
#define PBUS_CLK 15 /* Peripheral bus clock */
|
||||
#define PCM_CLK 16 /* PCM clock */
|
||||
#define PMDH_CLK 17 /* Primary MDDI host clock */
|
||||
#define SDAC_CLK 18 /* Stereo DAC clock */
|
||||
#define SDC1_CLK 19 /* Secure Digital Card clocks */
|
||||
#define SDC1_PCLK 20
|
||||
#define SDC2_CLK 21
|
||||
#define SDC2_PCLK 22
|
||||
#define SDC3_CLK 23
|
||||
#define SDC3_PCLK 24
|
||||
#define SDC4_CLK 25
|
||||
#define SDC4_PCLK 26
|
||||
#define TSIF_CLK 27 /* Transport Stream Interface clocks */
|
||||
#define TSIF_REF_CLK 28
|
||||
#define TV_DAC_CLK 29 /* TV clocks */
|
||||
#define TV_ENC_CLK 30
|
||||
#define UART1_CLK 31 /* UART clocks */
|
||||
#define UART2_CLK 32
|
||||
#define UART3_CLK 33
|
||||
#define UART1DM_CLK 34
|
||||
#define UART2DM_CLK 35
|
||||
#define USB_HS_CLK 36 /* High speed USB core clock */
|
||||
#define USB_HS_PCLK 37 /* High speed USB pbus clock */
|
||||
#define USB_OTG_CLK 38 /* Full speed USB clock */
|
||||
#define VDC_CLK 39 /* Video controller clock */
|
||||
#define VFE_CLK 40 /* Camera / Video Front End clock */
|
||||
#define VFE_MDC_CLK 41 /* VFE MDDI client clock */
|
||||
|
||||
#define NR_CLKS 42
|
||||
|
||||
#define CLOCK(clk_name, clk_id, clk_dev, clk_flags) { \
|
||||
.name = clk_name, \
|
||||
.id = clk_id, \
|
||||
.flags = clk_flags, \
|
||||
.dev = clk_dev, \
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
#define OFF CLKFLAG_AUTO_OFF
|
||||
#define MINMAX CLKFLAG_USE_MIN_MAX_TO_SET
|
||||
|
||||
struct clk msm_clocks[] = {
|
||||
CLOCK("adm_clk", ADM_CLK, NULL, 0),
|
||||
CLOCK("adsp_clk", ADSP_CLK, NULL, 0),
|
||||
CLOCK("ebi1_clk", EBI1_CLK, NULL, 0),
|
||||
CLOCK("ebi2_clk", EBI2_CLK, NULL, 0),
|
||||
CLOCK("ecodec_clk", ECODEC_CLK, NULL, 0),
|
||||
CLOCK("emdh_clk", EMDH_CLK, NULL, OFF),
|
||||
CLOCK("gp_clk", GP_CLK, NULL, 0),
|
||||
CLOCK("grp_clk", GRP_CLK, NULL, OFF),
|
||||
CLOCK("i2c_clk", I2C_CLK, &msm_device_i2c.dev, 0),
|
||||
CLOCK("icodec_rx_clk", ICODEC_RX_CLK, NULL, 0),
|
||||
CLOCK("icodec_tx_clk", ICODEC_TX_CLK, NULL, 0),
|
||||
CLOCK("imem_clk", IMEM_CLK, NULL, OFF),
|
||||
CLOCK("mdc_clk", MDC_CLK, NULL, 0),
|
||||
CLOCK("mdp_clk", MDP_CLK, NULL, OFF),
|
||||
CLOCK("pbus_clk", PBUS_CLK, NULL, 0),
|
||||
CLOCK("pcm_clk", PCM_CLK, NULL, 0),
|
||||
CLOCK("pmdh_clk", PMDH_CLK, NULL, OFF | MINMAX),
|
||||
CLOCK("sdac_clk", SDAC_CLK, NULL, OFF),
|
||||
CLOCK("sdc_clk", SDC1_CLK, &msm_device_sdc1.dev, OFF),
|
||||
CLOCK("sdc_pclk", SDC1_PCLK, &msm_device_sdc1.dev, OFF),
|
||||
CLOCK("sdc_clk", SDC2_CLK, &msm_device_sdc2.dev, OFF),
|
||||
CLOCK("sdc_pclk", SDC2_PCLK, &msm_device_sdc2.dev, OFF),
|
||||
CLOCK("sdc_clk", SDC3_CLK, &msm_device_sdc3.dev, OFF),
|
||||
CLOCK("sdc_pclk", SDC3_PCLK, &msm_device_sdc3.dev, OFF),
|
||||
CLOCK("sdc_clk", SDC4_CLK, &msm_device_sdc4.dev, OFF),
|
||||
CLOCK("sdc_pclk", SDC4_PCLK, &msm_device_sdc4.dev, OFF),
|
||||
CLOCK("tsif_clk", TSIF_CLK, NULL, 0),
|
||||
CLOCK("tsif_ref_clk", TSIF_REF_CLK, NULL, 0),
|
||||
CLOCK("tv_dac_clk", TV_DAC_CLK, NULL, 0),
|
||||
CLOCK("tv_enc_clk", TV_ENC_CLK, NULL, 0),
|
||||
CLOCK("uart_clk", UART1_CLK, &msm_device_uart1.dev, OFF),
|
||||
CLOCK("uart_clk", UART2_CLK, &msm_device_uart2.dev, 0),
|
||||
CLOCK("uart_clk", UART3_CLK, &msm_device_uart3.dev, OFF),
|
||||
CLOCK("uart1dm_clk", UART1DM_CLK, NULL, OFF),
|
||||
CLOCK("uart2dm_clk", UART2DM_CLK, NULL, 0),
|
||||
CLOCK("usb_hs_clk", USB_HS_CLK, &msm_device_hsusb.dev, OFF),
|
||||
CLOCK("usb_hs_pclk", USB_HS_PCLK, &msm_device_hsusb.dev, OFF),
|
||||
CLOCK("usb_otg_clk", USB_OTG_CLK, NULL, 0),
|
||||
CLOCK("vdc_clk", VDC_CLK, NULL, OFF | MINMAX),
|
||||
CLOCK("vfe_clk", VFE_CLK, NULL, OFF),
|
||||
CLOCK("vfe_mdc_clk", VFE_MDC_CLK, NULL, OFF),
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
unsigned msm_num_clocks = ARRAY_SIZE(msm_clocks);
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,218 @@
|
|||
/* arch/arm/mach-msm/clock.c
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Copyright (C) 2007 Google, Inc.
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2007 QUALCOMM Incorporated
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This software is licensed under the terms of the GNU General Public
|
||||
* License version 2, as published by the Free Software Foundation, and
|
||||
* may be copied, distributed, and modified under those terms.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
* GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include <linux/version.h>
|
||||
#include <linux/kernel.h>
|
||||
#include <linux/init.h>
|
||||
#include <linux/module.h>
|
||||
#include <linux/list.h>
|
||||
#include <linux/err.h>
|
||||
#include <linux/clk.h>
|
||||
#include <linux/spinlock.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "clock.h"
|
||||
#include "proc_comm.h"
|
||||
|
||||
static DEFINE_MUTEX(clocks_mutex);
|
||||
static DEFINE_SPINLOCK(clocks_lock);
|
||||
static LIST_HEAD(clocks);
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* glue for the proc_comm interface
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static inline int pc_clk_enable(unsigned id)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return msm_proc_comm(PCOM_CLKCTL_RPC_ENABLE, &id, NULL);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static inline void pc_clk_disable(unsigned id)
|
||||
{
|
||||
msm_proc_comm(PCOM_CLKCTL_RPC_DISABLE, &id, NULL);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static inline int pc_clk_set_rate(unsigned id, unsigned rate)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return msm_proc_comm(PCOM_CLKCTL_RPC_SET_RATE, &id, &rate);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static inline int pc_clk_set_min_rate(unsigned id, unsigned rate)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return msm_proc_comm(PCOM_CLKCTL_RPC_MIN_RATE, &id, &rate);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static inline int pc_clk_set_max_rate(unsigned id, unsigned rate)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return msm_proc_comm(PCOM_CLKCTL_RPC_MAX_RATE, &id, &rate);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static inline int pc_clk_set_flags(unsigned id, unsigned flags)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return msm_proc_comm(PCOM_CLKCTL_RPC_SET_FLAGS, &id, &flags);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static inline unsigned pc_clk_get_rate(unsigned id)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (msm_proc_comm(PCOM_CLKCTL_RPC_RATE, &id, NULL))
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
else
|
||||
return id;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static inline unsigned pc_clk_is_enabled(unsigned id)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (msm_proc_comm(PCOM_CLKCTL_RPC_ENABLED, &id, NULL))
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
else
|
||||
return id;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static inline int pc_pll_request(unsigned id, unsigned on)
|
||||
{
|
||||
on = !!on;
|
||||
return msm_proc_comm(PCOM_CLKCTL_RPC_PLL_REQUEST, &id, &on);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Standard clock functions defined in include/linux/clk.h
|
||||
*/
|
||||
struct clk *clk_get(struct device *dev, const char *id)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct clk *clk;
|
||||
|
||||
mutex_lock(&clocks_mutex);
|
||||
|
||||
list_for_each_entry(clk, &clocks, list)
|
||||
if (!strcmp(id, clk->name) && clk->dev == dev)
|
||||
goto found_it;
|
||||
|
||||
list_for_each_entry(clk, &clocks, list)
|
||||
if (!strcmp(id, clk->name) && clk->dev == NULL)
|
||||
goto found_it;
|
||||
|
||||
clk = ERR_PTR(-ENOENT);
|
||||
found_it:
|
||||
mutex_unlock(&clocks_mutex);
|
||||
return clk;
|
||||
}
|
||||
EXPORT_SYMBOL(clk_get);
|
||||
|
||||
void clk_put(struct clk *clk)
|
||||
{
|
||||
}
|
||||
EXPORT_SYMBOL(clk_put);
|
||||
|
||||
int clk_enable(struct clk *clk)
|
||||
{
|
||||
unsigned long flags;
|
||||
spin_lock_irqsave(&clocks_lock, flags);
|
||||
clk->count++;
|
||||
if (clk->count == 1)
|
||||
pc_clk_enable(clk->id);
|
||||
spin_unlock_irqrestore(&clocks_lock, flags);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
EXPORT_SYMBOL(clk_enable);
|
||||
|
||||
void clk_disable(struct clk *clk)
|
||||
{
|
||||
unsigned long flags;
|
||||
spin_lock_irqsave(&clocks_lock, flags);
|
||||
BUG_ON(clk->count == 0);
|
||||
clk->count--;
|
||||
if (clk->count == 0)
|
||||
pc_clk_disable(clk->id);
|
||||
spin_unlock_irqrestore(&clocks_lock, flags);
|
||||
}
|
||||
EXPORT_SYMBOL(clk_disable);
|
||||
|
||||
unsigned long clk_get_rate(struct clk *clk)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return pc_clk_get_rate(clk->id);
|
||||
}
|
||||
EXPORT_SYMBOL(clk_get_rate);
|
||||
|
||||
int clk_set_rate(struct clk *clk, unsigned long rate)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int ret;
|
||||
if (clk->flags & CLKFLAG_USE_MIN_MAX_TO_SET) {
|
||||
ret = pc_clk_set_max_rate(clk->id, rate);
|
||||
if (ret)
|
||||
return ret;
|
||||
return pc_clk_set_min_rate(clk->id, rate);
|
||||
}
|
||||
return pc_clk_set_rate(clk->id, rate);
|
||||
}
|
||||
EXPORT_SYMBOL(clk_set_rate);
|
||||
|
||||
int clk_set_parent(struct clk *clk, struct clk *parent)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return -ENOSYS;
|
||||
}
|
||||
EXPORT_SYMBOL(clk_set_parent);
|
||||
|
||||
struct clk *clk_get_parent(struct clk *clk)
|
||||
{
|
||||
return ERR_PTR(-ENOSYS);
|
||||
}
|
||||
EXPORT_SYMBOL(clk_get_parent);
|
||||
|
||||
int clk_set_flags(struct clk *clk, unsigned long flags)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (clk == NULL || IS_ERR(clk))
|
||||
return -EINVAL;
|
||||
return pc_clk_set_flags(clk->id, flags);
|
||||
}
|
||||
EXPORT_SYMBOL(clk_set_flags);
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
void __init msm_clock_init(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
unsigned n;
|
||||
|
||||
spin_lock_init(&clocks_lock);
|
||||
mutex_lock(&clocks_mutex);
|
||||
for (n = 0; n < msm_num_clocks; n++)
|
||||
list_add_tail(&msm_clocks[n].list, &clocks);
|
||||
mutex_unlock(&clocks_mutex);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
/* The bootloader and/or AMSS may have left various clocks enabled.
|
||||
* Disable any clocks that belong to us (CLKFLAG_AUTO_OFF) but have
|
||||
* not been explicitly enabled by a clk_enable() call.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
static int __init clock_late_init(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
unsigned long flags;
|
||||
struct clk *clk;
|
||||
unsigned count = 0;
|
||||
|
||||
mutex_lock(&clocks_mutex);
|
||||
list_for_each_entry(clk, &clocks, list) {
|
||||
if (clk->flags & CLKFLAG_AUTO_OFF) {
|
||||
spin_lock_irqsave(&clocks_lock, flags);
|
||||
if (!clk->count) {
|
||||
count++;
|
||||
pc_clk_disable(clk->id);
|
||||
}
|
||||
spin_unlock_irqrestore(&clocks_lock, flags);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
mutex_unlock(&clocks_mutex);
|
||||
pr_info("clock_late_init() disabled %d unused clocks\n", count);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
late_initcall(clock_late_init);
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,48 @@
|
|||
/* arch/arm/mach-msm/clock.h
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Copyright (C) 2007 Google, Inc.
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2007 QUALCOMM Incorporated
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This software is licensed under the terms of the GNU General Public
|
||||
* License version 2, as published by the Free Software Foundation, and
|
||||
* may be copied, distributed, and modified under those terms.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
* GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __ARCH_ARM_MACH_MSM_CLOCK_H
|
||||
#define __ARCH_ARM_MACH_MSM_CLOCK_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <linux/list.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#define CLKFLAG_INVERT 0x00000001
|
||||
#define CLKFLAG_NOINVERT 0x00000002
|
||||
#define CLKFLAG_NONEST 0x00000004
|
||||
#define CLKFLAG_NORESET 0x00000008
|
||||
|
||||
#define CLK_FIRST_AVAILABLE_FLAG 0x00000100
|
||||
#define CLKFLAG_USE_MIN_MAX_TO_SET 0x00000200
|
||||
#define CLKFLAG_AUTO_OFF 0x00000400
|
||||
|
||||
struct clk {
|
||||
uint32_t id;
|
||||
uint32_t count;
|
||||
uint32_t flags;
|
||||
const char *name;
|
||||
struct list_head list;
|
||||
struct device *dev;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
#define A11S_CLK_CNTL_ADDR (MSM_CSR_BASE + 0x100)
|
||||
#define A11S_CLK_SEL_ADDR (MSM_CSR_BASE + 0x104)
|
||||
#define A11S_VDD_SVS_PLEVEL_ADDR (MSM_CSR_BASE + 0x124)
|
||||
|
||||
extern struct clk msm_clocks[];
|
||||
extern unsigned msm_num_clocks;
|
||||
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
|
@ -1,116 +0,0 @@
|
|||
/* linux/arch/arm/mach-msm/common.c
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Common setup code for MSM7K Boards
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Copyright (C) 2007 Google, Inc.
|
||||
* Author: Brian Swetland <swetland@google.com>
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This software is licensed under the terms of the GNU General Public
|
||||
* License version 2, as published by the Free Software Foundation, and
|
||||
* may be copied, distributed, and modified under those terms.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
* GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include <linux/kernel.h>
|
||||
#include <linux/init.h>
|
||||
#include <linux/platform_device.h>
|
||||
#include <linux/io.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include <asm/mach/flash.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include <asm/setup.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include <linux/mtd/nand.h>
|
||||
#include <linux/mtd/partitions.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include <mach/msm_iomap.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include <mach/board.h>
|
||||
|
||||
struct flash_platform_data msm_nand_data = {
|
||||
.parts = 0,
|
||||
.nr_parts = 0,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static struct resource msm_nand_resources[] = {
|
||||
[0] = {
|
||||
.start = 7,
|
||||
.end = 7,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_DMA,
|
||||
},
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static struct platform_device msm_nand_device = {
|
||||
.name = "msm_nand",
|
||||
.id = -1,
|
||||
.num_resources = ARRAY_SIZE(msm_nand_resources),
|
||||
.resource = msm_nand_resources,
|
||||
.dev = {
|
||||
.platform_data = &msm_nand_data,
|
||||
},
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static struct platform_device msm_smd_device = {
|
||||
.name = "msm_smd",
|
||||
.id = -1,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static struct resource msm_i2c_resources[] = {
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = MSM_I2C_BASE,
|
||||
.end = MSM_I2C_BASE + MSM_I2C_SIZE - 1,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_MEM,
|
||||
},
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = INT_PWB_I2C,
|
||||
.end = INT_PWB_I2C,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_IRQ,
|
||||
},
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static struct platform_device msm_i2c_device = {
|
||||
.name = "msm_i2c",
|
||||
.id = 0,
|
||||
.num_resources = ARRAY_SIZE(msm_i2c_resources),
|
||||
.resource = msm_i2c_resources,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static struct resource usb_resources[] = {
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = MSM_HSUSB_PHYS,
|
||||
.end = MSM_HSUSB_PHYS + MSM_HSUSB_SIZE,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_MEM,
|
||||
},
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = INT_USB_HS,
|
||||
.end = INT_USB_HS,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_IRQ,
|
||||
},
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static struct platform_device msm_hsusb_device = {
|
||||
.name = "msm_hsusb",
|
||||
.id = -1,
|
||||
.num_resources = ARRAY_SIZE(usb_resources),
|
||||
.resource = usb_resources,
|
||||
.dev = {
|
||||
.coherent_dma_mask = 0xffffffff,
|
||||
},
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static struct platform_device *devices[] __initdata = {
|
||||
&msm_nand_device,
|
||||
&msm_smd_device,
|
||||
&msm_i2c_device,
|
||||
&msm_hsusb_device,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
void __init msm_add_devices(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
platform_add_devices(devices, ARRAY_SIZE(devices));
|
||||
}
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,267 @@
|
|||
/* linux/arch/arm/mach-msm/devices.c
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Copyright (C) 2008 Google, Inc.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This software is licensed under the terms of the GNU General Public
|
||||
* License version 2, as published by the Free Software Foundation, and
|
||||
* may be copied, distributed, and modified under those terms.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
* GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#include <linux/kernel.h>
|
||||
#include <linux/platform_device.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include <mach/msm_iomap.h>
|
||||
#include "devices.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#include <asm/mach/flash.h>
|
||||
#include <linux/mtd/nand.h>
|
||||
#include <linux/mtd/partitions.h>
|
||||
|
||||
static struct resource resources_uart1[] = {
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = INT_UART1,
|
||||
.end = INT_UART1,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_IRQ,
|
||||
},
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = MSM_UART1_PHYS,
|
||||
.end = MSM_UART1_PHYS + MSM_UART1_SIZE - 1,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_MEM,
|
||||
},
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static struct resource resources_uart2[] = {
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = INT_UART2,
|
||||
.end = INT_UART2,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_IRQ,
|
||||
},
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = MSM_UART2_PHYS,
|
||||
.end = MSM_UART2_PHYS + MSM_UART2_SIZE - 1,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_MEM,
|
||||
},
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static struct resource resources_uart3[] = {
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = INT_UART3,
|
||||
.end = INT_UART3,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_IRQ,
|
||||
},
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = MSM_UART3_PHYS,
|
||||
.end = MSM_UART3_PHYS + MSM_UART3_SIZE - 1,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_MEM,
|
||||
},
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
struct platform_device msm_device_uart1 = {
|
||||
.name = "msm_serial",
|
||||
.id = 0,
|
||||
.num_resources = ARRAY_SIZE(resources_uart1),
|
||||
.resource = resources_uart1,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
struct platform_device msm_device_uart2 = {
|
||||
.name = "msm_serial",
|
||||
.id = 1,
|
||||
.num_resources = ARRAY_SIZE(resources_uart2),
|
||||
.resource = resources_uart2,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
struct platform_device msm_device_uart3 = {
|
||||
.name = "msm_serial",
|
||||
.id = 2,
|
||||
.num_resources = ARRAY_SIZE(resources_uart3),
|
||||
.resource = resources_uart3,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static struct resource resources_i2c[] = {
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = MSM_I2C_PHYS,
|
||||
.end = MSM_I2C_PHYS + MSM_I2C_SIZE - 1,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_MEM,
|
||||
},
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = INT_PWB_I2C,
|
||||
.end = INT_PWB_I2C,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_IRQ,
|
||||
},
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
struct platform_device msm_device_i2c = {
|
||||
.name = "msm_i2c",
|
||||
.id = 0,
|
||||
.num_resources = ARRAY_SIZE(resources_i2c),
|
||||
.resource = resources_i2c,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static struct resource resources_hsusb[] = {
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = MSM_HSUSB_PHYS,
|
||||
.end = MSM_HSUSB_PHYS + MSM_HSUSB_SIZE,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_MEM,
|
||||
},
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = INT_USB_HS,
|
||||
.end = INT_USB_HS,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_IRQ,
|
||||
},
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
struct platform_device msm_device_hsusb = {
|
||||
.name = "msm_hsusb",
|
||||
.id = -1,
|
||||
.num_resources = ARRAY_SIZE(resources_hsusb),
|
||||
.resource = resources_hsusb,
|
||||
.dev = {
|
||||
.coherent_dma_mask = 0xffffffff,
|
||||
},
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
struct flash_platform_data msm_nand_data = {
|
||||
.parts = NULL,
|
||||
.nr_parts = 0,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static struct resource resources_nand[] = {
|
||||
[0] = {
|
||||
.start = 7,
|
||||
.end = 7,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_DMA,
|
||||
},
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
struct platform_device msm_device_nand = {
|
||||
.name = "msm_nand",
|
||||
.id = -1,
|
||||
.num_resources = ARRAY_SIZE(resources_nand),
|
||||
.resource = resources_nand,
|
||||
.dev = {
|
||||
.platform_data = &msm_nand_data,
|
||||
},
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
struct platform_device msm_device_smd = {
|
||||
.name = "msm_smd",
|
||||
.id = -1,
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static struct resource resources_sdc1[] = {
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = MSM_SDC1_PHYS,
|
||||
.end = MSM_SDC1_PHYS + MSM_SDC1_SIZE - 1,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_MEM,
|
||||
},
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = INT_SDC1_0,
|
||||
.end = INT_SDC1_1,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_IRQ,
|
||||
},
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = 8,
|
||||
.end = 8,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_DMA,
|
||||
},
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static struct resource resources_sdc2[] = {
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = MSM_SDC2_PHYS,
|
||||
.end = MSM_SDC2_PHYS + MSM_SDC2_SIZE - 1,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_MEM,
|
||||
},
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = INT_SDC2_0,
|
||||
.end = INT_SDC2_1,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_IRQ,
|
||||
},
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = 8,
|
||||
.end = 8,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_DMA,
|
||||
},
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static struct resource resources_sdc3[] = {
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = MSM_SDC3_PHYS,
|
||||
.end = MSM_SDC3_PHYS + MSM_SDC3_SIZE - 1,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_MEM,
|
||||
},
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = INT_SDC3_0,
|
||||
.end = INT_SDC3_1,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_IRQ,
|
||||
},
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = 8,
|
||||
.end = 8,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_DMA,
|
||||
},
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static struct resource resources_sdc4[] = {
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = MSM_SDC4_PHYS,
|
||||
.end = MSM_SDC4_PHYS + MSM_SDC4_SIZE - 1,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_MEM,
|
||||
},
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = INT_SDC4_0,
|
||||
.end = INT_SDC4_1,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_IRQ,
|
||||
},
|
||||
{
|
||||
.start = 8,
|
||||
.end = 8,
|
||||
.flags = IORESOURCE_DMA,
|
||||
},
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
struct platform_device msm_device_sdc1 = {
|
||||
.name = "msm_sdcc",
|
||||
.id = 1,
|
||||
.num_resources = ARRAY_SIZE(resources_sdc1),
|
||||
.resource = resources_sdc1,
|
||||
.dev = {
|
||||
.coherent_dma_mask = 0xffffffff,
|
||||
},
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
struct platform_device msm_device_sdc2 = {
|
||||
.name = "msm_sdcc",
|
||||
.id = 2,
|
||||
.num_resources = ARRAY_SIZE(resources_sdc2),
|
||||
.resource = resources_sdc2,
|
||||
.dev = {
|
||||
.coherent_dma_mask = 0xffffffff,
|
||||
},
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
struct platform_device msm_device_sdc3 = {
|
||||
.name = "msm_sdcc",
|
||||
.id = 3,
|
||||
.num_resources = ARRAY_SIZE(resources_sdc3),
|
||||
.resource = resources_sdc3,
|
||||
.dev = {
|
||||
.coherent_dma_mask = 0xffffffff,
|
||||
},
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
struct platform_device msm_device_sdc4 = {
|
||||
.name = "msm_sdcc",
|
||||
.id = 4,
|
||||
.num_resources = ARRAY_SIZE(resources_sdc4),
|
||||
.resource = resources_sdc4,
|
||||
.dev = {
|
||||
.coherent_dma_mask = 0xffffffff,
|
||||
},
|
||||
};
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,36 @@
|
|||
/* linux/arch/arm/mach-msm/devices.h
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Copyright (C) 2008 Google, Inc.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This software is licensed under the terms of the GNU General Public
|
||||
* License version 2, as published by the Free Software Foundation, and
|
||||
* may be copied, distributed, and modified under those terms.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
* GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __ARCH_ARM_MACH_MSM_DEVICES_H
|
||||
#define __ARCH_ARM_MACH_MSM_DEVICES_H
|
||||
|
||||
extern struct platform_device msm_device_uart1;
|
||||
extern struct platform_device msm_device_uart2;
|
||||
extern struct platform_device msm_device_uart3;
|
||||
|
||||
extern struct platform_device msm_device_sdc1;
|
||||
extern struct platform_device msm_device_sdc2;
|
||||
extern struct platform_device msm_device_sdc3;
|
||||
extern struct platform_device msm_device_sdc4;
|
||||
|
||||
extern struct platform_device msm_device_hsusb;
|
||||
|
||||
extern struct platform_device msm_device_i2c;
|
||||
|
||||
extern struct platform_device msm_device_smd;
|
||||
|
||||
extern struct platform_device msm_device_nand;
|
||||
|
||||
#endif
|
|
@ -26,7 +26,7 @@ enum {
|
|||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static DEFINE_SPINLOCK(msm_dmov_lock);
|
||||
static struct msm_dmov_cmd active_command;
|
||||
static unsigned int channel_active;
|
||||
static struct list_head ready_commands[MSM_DMOV_CHANNEL_COUNT];
|
||||
static struct list_head active_commands[MSM_DMOV_CHANNEL_COUNT];
|
||||
unsigned int msm_dmov_print_mask = MSM_DMOV_PRINT_ERRORS;
|
||||
|
@ -43,6 +43,11 @@ unsigned int msm_dmov_print_mask = MSM_DMOV_PRINT_ERRORS;
|
|||
#define PRINT_FLOW(format, args...) \
|
||||
MSM_DMOV_DPRINTF(MSM_DMOV_PRINT_FLOW, format, args);
|
||||
|
||||
void msm_dmov_stop_cmd(unsigned id, struct msm_dmov_cmd *cmd, int graceful)
|
||||
{
|
||||
writel((graceful << 31), DMOV_FLUSH0(id));
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
void msm_dmov_enqueue_cmd(unsigned id, struct msm_dmov_cmd *cmd)
|
||||
{
|
||||
unsigned long irq_flags;
|
||||
|
@ -60,6 +65,9 @@ void msm_dmov_enqueue_cmd(unsigned id, struct msm_dmov_cmd *cmd)
|
|||
#endif
|
||||
PRINT_IO("msm_dmov_enqueue_cmd(%d), start command, status %x\n", id, status);
|
||||
list_add_tail(&cmd->list, &active_commands[id]);
|
||||
if (!channel_active)
|
||||
enable_irq(INT_ADM_AARM);
|
||||
channel_active |= 1U << id;
|
||||
writel(cmd->cmdptr, DMOV_CMD_PTR(id));
|
||||
} else {
|
||||
if (list_empty(&active_commands[id]))
|
||||
|
@ -76,21 +84,19 @@ struct msm_dmov_exec_cmdptr_cmd {
|
|||
struct completion complete;
|
||||
unsigned id;
|
||||
unsigned int result;
|
||||
unsigned int flush[6];
|
||||
struct msm_dmov_errdata err;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
static void dmov_exec_cmdptr_complete_func(struct msm_dmov_cmd *_cmd, unsigned int result)
|
||||
static void
|
||||
dmov_exec_cmdptr_complete_func(struct msm_dmov_cmd *_cmd,
|
||||
unsigned int result,
|
||||
struct msm_dmov_errdata *err)
|
||||
{
|
||||
struct msm_dmov_exec_cmdptr_cmd *cmd = container_of(_cmd, struct msm_dmov_exec_cmdptr_cmd, dmov_cmd);
|
||||
cmd->result = result;
|
||||
if (result != 0x80000002) {
|
||||
cmd->flush[0] = readl(DMOV_FLUSH0(cmd->id));
|
||||
cmd->flush[1] = readl(DMOV_FLUSH1(cmd->id));
|
||||
cmd->flush[2] = readl(DMOV_FLUSH2(cmd->id));
|
||||
cmd->flush[3] = readl(DMOV_FLUSH3(cmd->id));
|
||||
cmd->flush[4] = readl(DMOV_FLUSH4(cmd->id));
|
||||
cmd->flush[5] = readl(DMOV_FLUSH5(cmd->id));
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (result != 0x80000002 && err)
|
||||
memcpy(&cmd->err, err, sizeof(struct msm_dmov_errdata));
|
||||
|
||||
complete(&cmd->complete);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -111,7 +117,7 @@ int msm_dmov_exec_cmd(unsigned id, unsigned int cmdptr)
|
|||
if (cmd.result != 0x80000002) {
|
||||
PRINT_ERROR("dmov_exec_cmdptr(%d): ERROR, result: %x\n", id, cmd.result);
|
||||
PRINT_ERROR("dmov_exec_cmdptr(%d): flush: %x %x %x %x\n",
|
||||
id, cmd.flush[0], cmd.flush[1], cmd.flush[2], cmd.flush[3]);
|
||||
id, cmd.err.flush[0], cmd.err.flush[1], cmd.err.flush[2], cmd.err.flush[3]);
|
||||
return -EIO;
|
||||
}
|
||||
PRINT_FLOW("dmov_exec_cmdptr(%d, %x) done\n", id, cmdptr);
|
||||
|
@ -159,25 +165,40 @@ static irqreturn_t msm_datamover_irq_handler(int irq, void *dev_id)
|
|||
"for %p, result %x\n", id, cmd, ch_result);
|
||||
if (cmd) {
|
||||
list_del(&cmd->list);
|
||||
cmd->complete_func(cmd, ch_result);
|
||||
cmd->complete_func(cmd, ch_result, NULL);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (ch_result & DMOV_RSLT_FLUSH) {
|
||||
unsigned int flush0 = readl(DMOV_FLUSH0(id));
|
||||
struct msm_dmov_errdata errdata;
|
||||
|
||||
errdata.flush[0] = readl(DMOV_FLUSH0(id));
|
||||
errdata.flush[1] = readl(DMOV_FLUSH1(id));
|
||||
errdata.flush[2] = readl(DMOV_FLUSH2(id));
|
||||
errdata.flush[3] = readl(DMOV_FLUSH3(id));
|
||||
errdata.flush[4] = readl(DMOV_FLUSH4(id));
|
||||
errdata.flush[5] = readl(DMOV_FLUSH5(id));
|
||||
PRINT_FLOW("msm_datamover_irq_handler id %d, status %x\n", id, ch_status);
|
||||
PRINT_FLOW("msm_datamover_irq_handler id %d, flush, result %x, flush0 %x\n", id, ch_result, flush0);
|
||||
PRINT_FLOW("msm_datamover_irq_handler id %d, flush, result %x, flush0 %x\n", id, ch_result, errdata.flush[0]);
|
||||
if (cmd) {
|
||||
list_del(&cmd->list);
|
||||
cmd->complete_func(cmd, ch_result);
|
||||
cmd->complete_func(cmd, ch_result, &errdata);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (ch_result & DMOV_RSLT_ERROR) {
|
||||
unsigned int flush0 = readl(DMOV_FLUSH0(id));
|
||||
struct msm_dmov_errdata errdata;
|
||||
|
||||
errdata.flush[0] = readl(DMOV_FLUSH0(id));
|
||||
errdata.flush[1] = readl(DMOV_FLUSH1(id));
|
||||
errdata.flush[2] = readl(DMOV_FLUSH2(id));
|
||||
errdata.flush[3] = readl(DMOV_FLUSH3(id));
|
||||
errdata.flush[4] = readl(DMOV_FLUSH4(id));
|
||||
errdata.flush[5] = readl(DMOV_FLUSH5(id));
|
||||
|
||||
PRINT_ERROR("msm_datamover_irq_handler id %d, status %x\n", id, ch_status);
|
||||
PRINT_ERROR("msm_datamover_irq_handler id %d, error, result %x, flush0 %x\n", id, ch_result, flush0);
|
||||
PRINT_ERROR("msm_datamover_irq_handler id %d, error, result %x, flush0 %x\n", id, ch_result, errdata.flush[0]);
|
||||
if (cmd) {
|
||||
list_del(&cmd->list);
|
||||
cmd->complete_func(cmd, ch_result);
|
||||
cmd->complete_func(cmd, ch_result, &errdata);
|
||||
}
|
||||
/* this does not seem to work, once we get an error */
|
||||
/* the datamover will no longer accept commands */
|
||||
|
@ -193,8 +214,14 @@ static irqreturn_t msm_datamover_irq_handler(int irq, void *dev_id)
|
|||
writel(cmd->cmdptr, DMOV_CMD_PTR(id));
|
||||
}
|
||||
} while (ch_status & DMOV_STATUS_RSLT_VALID);
|
||||
if (list_empty(&active_commands[id]) && list_empty(&ready_commands[id]))
|
||||
channel_active &= ~(1U << id);
|
||||
PRINT_FLOW("msm_datamover_irq_handler id %d, status %x\n", id, ch_status);
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
if (!channel_active)
|
||||
disable_irq(INT_ADM_AARM);
|
||||
|
||||
spin_unlock_irqrestore(&msm_dmov_lock, irq_flags);
|
||||
return IRQ_HANDLED;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
@ -202,12 +229,17 @@ static irqreturn_t msm_datamover_irq_handler(int irq, void *dev_id)
|
|||
static int __init msm_init_datamover(void)
|
||||
{
|
||||
int i;
|
||||
int ret;
|
||||
for (i = 0; i < MSM_DMOV_CHANNEL_COUNT; i++) {
|
||||
INIT_LIST_HEAD(&ready_commands[i]);
|
||||
INIT_LIST_HEAD(&active_commands[i]);
|
||||
writel(DMOV_CONFIG_IRQ_EN | DMOV_CONFIG_FORCE_TOP_PTR_RSLT | DMOV_CONFIG_FORCE_FLUSH_RSLT, DMOV_CONFIG(i));
|
||||
}
|
||||
return request_irq(INT_ADM_AARM, msm_datamover_irq_handler, 0, "msmdatamover", NULL);
|
||||
ret = request_irq(INT_ADM_AARM, msm_datamover_irq_handler, 0, "msmdatamover", NULL);
|
||||
if (ret)
|
||||
return ret;
|
||||
disable_irq(INT_ADM_AARM);
|
||||
return 0;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
arch_initcall(msm_init_datamover);
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -33,5 +33,6 @@ void __init msm_add_devices(void);
|
|||
void __init msm_map_common_io(void);
|
||||
void __init msm_init_irq(void);
|
||||
void __init msm_init_gpio(void);
|
||||
void __init msm_clock_init(void);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -22,18 +22,22 @@
|
|||
mrc p15, 0, \rx, c1, c0
|
||||
tst \rx, #1
|
||||
ldreq \rx, =MSM_UART1_PHYS
|
||||
ldrne \rx, =MSM_UART1_BASE
|
||||
movne \rx, #0
|
||||
.endm
|
||||
|
||||
.macro senduart,rd,rx
|
||||
str \rd, [\rx, #0x0C]
|
||||
teq \rx, #0
|
||||
strne \rd, [\rx, #0x0C]
|
||||
.endm
|
||||
|
||||
.macro waituart,rd,rx
|
||||
@ wait for TX_READY
|
||||
teq \rx, #0
|
||||
bne 2f
|
||||
1: ldr \rd, [\rx, #0x08]
|
||||
tst \rd, #0x04
|
||||
beq 1b
|
||||
2:
|
||||
.endm
|
||||
|
||||
.macro busyuart,rd,rx
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
|||
/* arch/arm/mach-msm/include/mach/dma.h
|
||||
/* linux/include/asm-arm/arch-msm/dma.h
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Copyright (C) 2007 Google, Inc.
|
||||
*
|
||||
|
@ -18,17 +18,21 @@
|
|||
#include <linux/list.h>
|
||||
#include <mach/msm_iomap.h>
|
||||
|
||||
struct msm_dmov_errdata {
|
||||
uint32_t flush[6];
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
struct msm_dmov_cmd {
|
||||
struct list_head list;
|
||||
unsigned int cmdptr;
|
||||
void (*complete_func)(struct msm_dmov_cmd *cmd, unsigned int result);
|
||||
/* void (*user_result_func)(struct msm_dmov_cmd *cmd); */
|
||||
void (*complete_func)(struct msm_dmov_cmd *cmd,
|
||||
unsigned int result,
|
||||
struct msm_dmov_errdata *err);
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
void msm_dmov_enqueue_cmd(unsigned id, struct msm_dmov_cmd *cmd);
|
||||
void msm_dmov_stop_cmd(unsigned id, struct msm_dmov_cmd *cmd);
|
||||
void msm_dmov_stop_cmd(unsigned id, struct msm_dmov_cmd *cmd, int graceful);
|
||||
int msm_dmov_exec_cmd(unsigned id, unsigned int cmdptr);
|
||||
/* int msm_dmov_exec_cmd_etc(unsigned id, unsigned int cmdptr, int timeout, int interruptible); */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -122,6 +126,16 @@ typedef struct {
|
|||
unsigned _reserved;
|
||||
} dmov_sg;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Box mode */
|
||||
typedef struct {
|
||||
uint32_t cmd;
|
||||
uint32_t src_row_addr;
|
||||
uint32_t dst_row_addr;
|
||||
uint32_t src_dst_len;
|
||||
uint32_t num_rows;
|
||||
uint32_t row_offset;
|
||||
} dmov_box;
|
||||
|
||||
/* bits for the cmd field of the above structures */
|
||||
|
||||
#define CMD_LC (1 << 31) /* last command */
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -37,11 +37,17 @@
|
|||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_VIC_BASE 0xE0000000
|
||||
#ifdef __ASSEMBLY__
|
||||
#define IOMEM(x) x
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#define IOMEM(x) ((void __force __iomem *)(x))
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_VIC_BASE IOMEM(0xE0000000)
|
||||
#define MSM_VIC_PHYS 0xC0000000
|
||||
#define MSM_VIC_SIZE SZ_4K
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_CSR_BASE 0xE0001000
|
||||
#define MSM_CSR_BASE IOMEM(0xE0001000)
|
||||
#define MSM_CSR_PHYS 0xC0100000
|
||||
#define MSM_CSR_SIZE SZ_4K
|
||||
|
||||
|
@ -49,56 +55,67 @@
|
|||
#define MSM_GPT_BASE MSM_CSR_BASE
|
||||
#define MSM_GPT_SIZE SZ_4K
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_DMOV_BASE 0xE0002000
|
||||
#define MSM_DMOV_BASE IOMEM(0xE0002000)
|
||||
#define MSM_DMOV_PHYS 0xA9700000
|
||||
#define MSM_DMOV_SIZE SZ_4K
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_UART1_BASE 0xE0003000
|
||||
#define MSM_UART1_PHYS 0xA9A00000
|
||||
#define MSM_UART1_SIZE SZ_4K
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_UART2_BASE 0xE0004000
|
||||
#define MSM_UART2_PHYS 0xA9B00000
|
||||
#define MSM_UART2_SIZE SZ_4K
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_UART3_BASE 0xE0005000
|
||||
#define MSM_UART3_PHYS 0xA9C00000
|
||||
#define MSM_UART3_SIZE SZ_4K
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_I2C_BASE 0xE0006000
|
||||
#define MSM_I2C_PHYS 0xA9900000
|
||||
#define MSM_I2C_SIZE SZ_4K
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_GPIO1_BASE 0xE0007000
|
||||
#define MSM_GPIO1_BASE IOMEM(0xE0003000)
|
||||
#define MSM_GPIO1_PHYS 0xA9200000
|
||||
#define MSM_GPIO1_SIZE SZ_4K
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_GPIO2_BASE 0xE0008000
|
||||
#define MSM_GPIO2_BASE IOMEM(0xE0004000)
|
||||
#define MSM_GPIO2_PHYS 0xA9300000
|
||||
#define MSM_GPIO2_SIZE SZ_4K
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_HSUSB_BASE 0xE0009000
|
||||
#define MSM_HSUSB_PHYS 0xA0800000
|
||||
#define MSM_HSUSB_SIZE SZ_4K
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_CLK_CTL_BASE 0xE000A000
|
||||
#define MSM_CLK_CTL_BASE IOMEM(0xE0005000)
|
||||
#define MSM_CLK_CTL_PHYS 0xA8600000
|
||||
#define MSM_CLK_CTL_SIZE SZ_4K
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_PMDH_BASE 0xE000B000
|
||||
#define MSM_PMDH_PHYS 0xAA600000
|
||||
#define MSM_PMDH_SIZE SZ_4K
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_EMDH_BASE 0xE000C000
|
||||
#define MSM_EMDH_PHYS 0xAA700000
|
||||
#define MSM_EMDH_SIZE SZ_4K
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_MDP_BASE 0xE0010000
|
||||
#define MSM_MDP_PHYS 0xAA200000
|
||||
#define MSM_MDP_SIZE 0x000F0000
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_SHARED_RAM_BASE 0xE0100000
|
||||
#define MSM_SHARED_RAM_BASE IOMEM(0xE0100000)
|
||||
#define MSM_SHARED_RAM_PHYS 0x01F00000
|
||||
#define MSM_SHARED_RAM_SIZE SZ_1M
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_UART1_PHYS 0xA9A00000
|
||||
#define MSM_UART1_SIZE SZ_4K
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_UART2_PHYS 0xA9B00000
|
||||
#define MSM_UART2_SIZE SZ_4K
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_UART3_PHYS 0xA9C00000
|
||||
#define MSM_UART3_SIZE SZ_4K
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_SDC1_PHYS 0xA0400000
|
||||
#define MSM_SDC1_SIZE SZ_4K
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_SDC2_PHYS 0xA0500000
|
||||
#define MSM_SDC2_SIZE SZ_4K
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_SDC3_PHYS 0xA0600000
|
||||
#define MSM_SDC3_SIZE SZ_4K
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_SDC4_PHYS 0xA0700000
|
||||
#define MSM_SDC4_SIZE SZ_4K
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_I2C_PHYS 0xA9900000
|
||||
#define MSM_I2C_SIZE SZ_4K
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_HSUSB_PHYS 0xA0800000
|
||||
#define MSM_HSUSB_SIZE SZ_4K
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_PMDH_PHYS 0xAA600000
|
||||
#define MSM_PMDH_SIZE SZ_4K
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_EMDH_PHYS 0xAA700000
|
||||
#define MSM_EMDH_SIZE SZ_4K
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_MDP_PHYS 0xAA200000
|
||||
#define MSM_MDP_SIZE 0x000F0000
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_MDC_PHYS 0xAA500000
|
||||
#define MSM_MDC_SIZE SZ_1M
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_AD5_PHYS 0xAC000000
|
||||
#define MSM_AD5_SIZE (SZ_1M*13)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
|
|
@ -0,0 +1,29 @@
|
|||
/* linux/include/asm-arm/arch-msm/vreg.h
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Copyright (C) 2008 Google, Inc.
|
||||
* Author: Brian Swetland <swetland@google.com>
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This software is licensed under the terms of the GNU General Public
|
||||
* License version 2, as published by the Free Software Foundation, and
|
||||
* may be copied, distributed, and modified under those terms.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
|
||||
* but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
|
||||
* MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
|
||||
* GNU General Public License for more details.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __ARCH_ARM_MACH_MSM_VREG_H
|
||||
#define __ARCH_ARM_MACH_MSM_VREG_H
|
||||
|
||||
struct vreg;
|
||||
|
||||
struct vreg *vreg_get(struct device *dev, const char *id);
|
||||
void vreg_put(struct vreg *vreg);
|
||||
|
||||
int vreg_enable(struct vreg *vreg);
|
||||
void vreg_disable(struct vreg *vreg);
|
||||
int vreg_set_level(struct vreg *vreg, unsigned mv);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif
|
|
@ -28,7 +28,7 @@
|
|||
#include <mach/board.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#define MSM_DEVICE(name) { \
|
||||
.virtual = MSM_##name##_BASE, \
|
||||
.virtual = (unsigned long) MSM_##name##_BASE, \
|
||||
.pfn = __phys_to_pfn(MSM_##name##_PHYS), \
|
||||
.length = MSM_##name##_SIZE, \
|
||||
.type = MT_DEVICE_NONSHARED, \
|
||||
|
@ -39,19 +39,11 @@ static struct map_desc msm_io_desc[] __initdata = {
|
|||
MSM_DEVICE(CSR),
|
||||
MSM_DEVICE(GPT),
|
||||
MSM_DEVICE(DMOV),
|
||||
MSM_DEVICE(UART1),
|
||||
MSM_DEVICE(UART2),
|
||||
MSM_DEVICE(UART3),
|
||||
MSM_DEVICE(I2C),
|
||||
MSM_DEVICE(GPIO1),
|
||||
MSM_DEVICE(GPIO2),
|
||||
MSM_DEVICE(HSUSB),
|
||||
MSM_DEVICE(CLK_CTL),
|
||||
MSM_DEVICE(PMDH),
|
||||
MSM_DEVICE(EMDH),
|
||||
MSM_DEVICE(MDP),
|
||||
{
|
||||
.virtual = MSM_SHARED_RAM_BASE,
|
||||
.virtual = (unsigned long) MSM_SHARED_RAM_BASE,
|
||||
.pfn = __phys_to_pfn(MSM_SHARED_RAM_PHYS),
|
||||
.length = MSM_SHARED_RAM_SIZE,
|
||||
.type = MT_DEVICE,
|
||||
|
|
Some files were not shown because too many files have changed in this diff Show More
Loading…
Reference in New Issue